doc: "filesystem" -> "file system"
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 090B11993D9AEBB5
14
15 @copying
16 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016 Ludovic Courtès@*
17 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
18 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
19 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
20 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
21 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
22 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
23 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Leo Famulari@*
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Ricardo Wurmus@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Chris Marusich@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Efraim Flashner@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 ng0
30
31 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
32 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
33 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
34 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
35 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
36 Documentation License''.
37 @end copying
38
39 @dircategory System administration
40 @direntry
41 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
42 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
43 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
44 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
45 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
46 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
47 @end direntry
48
49 @dircategory Software development
50 @direntry
51 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
52 @end direntry
53
54 @dircategory Emacs
55 @direntry
56 * Guix user interface: (guix)Emacs Interface. Package management from the comfort of Emacs.
57 @end direntry
58
59
60 @titlepage
61 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
62 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
63 @author The GNU Guix Developers
64
65 @page
66 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
67 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
68 @value{UPDATED} @*
69
70 @insertcopying
71 @end titlepage
72
73 @contents
74
75 @c *********************************************************************
76 @node Top
77 @top GNU Guix
78
79 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
80 package management tool written for the GNU system.
81
82 @menu
83 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
84 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
85 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
86 * Emacs Interface:: Using Guix from Emacs.
87 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
88 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
89 * GNU Distribution:: Software for your friendly GNU system.
90 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
91
92 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
93 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
94 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
95 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
96
97 @detailmenu
98 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
99
100 Installation
101
102 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
103 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
104 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
105 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
106 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
107 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
108
109 Setting Up the Daemon
110
111 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
112 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
113
114 Package Management
115
116 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
117 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
118 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
119 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
120 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
121 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
122 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
123
124 Emacs Interface
125
126 * Initial Setup: Emacs Initial Setup. Preparing @file{~/.emacs}.
127 * Package Management: Emacs Package Management. Managing packages and generations.
128 * Licenses: Emacs Licenses. Interface for licenses of Guix packages.
129 * Package Source Locations: Emacs Package Locations. Interface for package location files.
130 * Popup Interface: Emacs Popup Interface. Magit-like interface for guix commands.
131 * Prettify Mode: Emacs Prettify. Abbreviating @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}} file names.
132 * Build Log Mode: Emacs Build Log. Highlighting Guix build logs.
133 * Completions: Emacs Completions. Completing @command{guix} shell command.
134 * Development: Emacs Development. Tools for Guix developers.
135 * Hydra: Emacs Hydra. Interface for Guix build farm.
136
137 Programming Interface
138
139 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
140 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
141 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
142 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
143 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
144 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
145
146 Defining Packages
147
148 * package Reference:: The package data type.
149 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
150
151 Utilities
152
153 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
154 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
155 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
156 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
157 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
158 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
159 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
160 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
161 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
162 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
163 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
164 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
165 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
166
167 Invoking @command{guix build}
168
169 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
170 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
171 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
172
173 GNU Distribution
174
175 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
176 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
177 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
178 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
179 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
180 * Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
181 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
182 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
183
184 System Installation
185
186 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
187 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
188 * USB Stick Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
189 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
190 * Proceeding with the Installation:: The real thing.
191 * Installing GuixSD in a VM:: GuixSD playground.
192 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
193
194 System Configuration
195
196 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
197 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
198 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
199 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
200 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
201 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
202 * Services:: Specifying system services.
203 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
204 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
205 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
206 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
207 * GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
208 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
209 * Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
210 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
211
212 Services
213
214 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
215 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
216 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
217 * X Window:: Graphical display.
218 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
219 * Database Services:: SQL databases.
220 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
221 * Web Services:: Web servers.
222 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
223
224 Defining Services
225
226 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
227 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
228 * Service Reference:: API reference.
229 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
230
231 Packaging Guidelines
232
233 * Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
234 * Package Naming:: What's in a name?
235 * Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
236 * Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
237 * Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
238 * Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
239 * Java Packages:: Coffee break.
240 * Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
241
242 Contributing
243
244 * Building from Git:: The latest and greatest.
245 * Running Guix Before It Is Installed:: Hacker tricks.
246 * The Perfect Setup:: The right tools.
247 * Coding Style:: Hygiene of the contributor.
248 * Submitting Patches:: Share your work.
249
250 Coding Style
251
252 * Programming Paradigm:: How to compose your elements.
253 * Modules:: Where to store your code?
254 * Data Types and Pattern Matching:: Implementing data structures.
255 * Formatting Code:: Writing conventions.
256
257 @end detailmenu
258 @end menu
259
260 @c *********************************************************************
261 @node Introduction
262 @chapter Introduction
263
264 @cindex purpose
265 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
266 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
267 management tool for the GNU system. Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
268 users to install, upgrade, or remove packages, to roll back to a
269 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
270 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
271
272 @cindex user interfaces
273 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
274 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}), a set of command-line utilities
275 (@pxref{Utilities}), a visual user interface in Emacs (@pxref{Emacs
276 Interface}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
277 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
278 @cindex build daemon
279 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
280 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
281 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
282
283 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
284 @cindex customization of packages
285 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
286 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
287 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
288 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
289 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
290 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
291 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
292 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
293
294 @cindex Guix System Distribution
295 @cindex GuixSD
296 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system
297 where it complements the available tools without interference
298 (@pxref{Installation}), or you can use it as part of the standalone
299 @dfn{Guix System Distribution} or GuixSD (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
300 With GNU@tie{}GuixSD, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating
301 system configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the
302 configuration in a transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion
303 (@pxref{System Configuration}).
304
305 @cindex functional package management
306 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
307 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
308 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
309 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
310 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
311 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
312 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
313 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
314 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
315 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
316 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
317 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
318 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
319 explicit inputs are visible.
320
321 @cindex store
322 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
323 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
324 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
325 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
326 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
327 input yields a different directory name.
328
329 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
330 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
331 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
332
333
334 @c *********************************************************************
335 @node Installation
336 @chapter Installation
337
338 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
339 @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}. This section describes the
340 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it and get
341 ready to use it.
342
343 Note that this section is concerned with the installation of the package
344 manager, which can be done on top of a running GNU/Linux system. If,
345 instead, you want to install the complete GNU operating system,
346 @pxref{System Installation}.
347
348 @cindex foreign distro
349 When installed on a running GNU/Linux system---thereafter called a
350 @dfn{foreign distro}---GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available tools
351 without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
352 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your
353 system, such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
354
355 @menu
356 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
357 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
358 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
359 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
360 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
361 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
362 @end menu
363
364 @node Binary Installation
365 @section Binary Installation
366
367 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
368 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
369 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
370 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
371 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
372
373 Installing goes along these lines:
374
375 @enumerate
376 @item
377 Download the binary tarball from
378 @indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
379 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
380 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
381
382 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
383 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
384 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
385
386 @example
387 $ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
388 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
389 @end example
390
391 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
392 then run this command to import it:
393
394 @example
395 $ gpg --keyserver pgp.mit.edu --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
396 @end example
397
398 @noindent
399 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
400 @c end authentication part
401
402 @item
403 As @code{root}, run:
404
405 @example
406 # cd /tmp
407 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
408 guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
409 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
410 @end example
411
412 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
413 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
414 step.)
415
416 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
417 would overwrite its own essential files.
418
419 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
420 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
421 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
422 versions are fine.)
423 They stem from the fact that all the
424 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
425 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
426 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
427 reproducible.
428
429 @item
430 Make @code{root}'s profile available under @file{~/.guix-profile}:
431
432 @example
433 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile \
434 ~root/.guix-profile
435 @end example
436
437 @item
438 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
439 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
440
441 @item
442 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
443
444 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
445 with these commands:
446
447 @example
448 # cp ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
449 /etc/systemd/system/
450 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
451 @end example
452
453 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
454
455 @example
456 # cp ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf /etc/init/
457 # start guix-daemon
458 @end example
459
460 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
461
462 @example
463 # ~root/.guix-profile/bin/guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
464 @end example
465
466 @item
467 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
468 for instance with:
469
470 @example
471 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
472 # cd /usr/local/bin
473 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/bin/guix
474 @end example
475
476 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
477 there:
478
479 @example
480 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
481 # cd /usr/local/share/info
482 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/share/info/* ;
483 do ln -s $i ; done
484 @end example
485
486 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
487 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
488 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
489 Info search path.)
490
491 @item
492 To use substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} or one of its mirrors
493 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
494
495 @example
496 # guix archive --authorize < ~root/.guix-profile/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub
497 @end example
498 @end enumerate
499
500 This completes root-level install of Guix. Each user will need to
501 perform additional steps to make their Guix environment ready for use,
502 @pxref{Application Setup}.
503
504 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
505 the root profile:
506
507 @example
508 # guix package -i hello
509 @end example
510
511 The @code{guix} package must remain available in @code{root}'s profile,
512 or it would become subject to garbage collection---in which case you
513 would find yourself badly handicapped by the lack of the @command{guix}
514 command. In other words, do not remove @code{guix} by running
515 @code{guix package -r guix}.
516
517 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
518 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
519
520 @example
521 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
522 @end example
523
524
525 @node Requirements
526 @section Requirements
527
528 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
529 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
530 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
531 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
532
533 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
534
535 @itemize
536 @item @url{http://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.0.7 or later;
537 @item @url{http://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
538 @item @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
539 @end itemize
540
541 The following dependencies are optional:
542
543 @itemize
544 @item
545 Installing @uref{http://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS-Guile} will allow you to
546 access @code{https} URLs for substitutes, which is highly recommended
547 (@pxref{Substitutes}). It also allows you to access HTTPS URLs with the
548 @command{guix download} command (@pxref{Invoking guix download}), the
549 @command{guix import pypi} command, and the @command{guix import cpan}
550 command. @xref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings
551 for Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile}.
552
553 @item
554 Installing
555 @url{http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} will
556 allow you to use the @command{guix import pypi} command (@pxref{Invoking
557 guix import}). It is of
558 interest primarily for developers and not for casual users.
559
560 @item
561 When @url{http://zlib.net, zlib} is available, @command{guix publish}
562 can compress build byproducts (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
563 @end itemize
564
565 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
566 following packages are also needed:
567
568 @itemize
569 @item @url{http://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
570 @item @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2};
571 @item @url{http://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
572 C++11 standard.
573 @end itemize
574
575 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
576 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
577 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
578 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
579 GNU Coding Standards}). The @command{configure} script protects against
580 unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
581 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
582
583 When a working installation of @url{http://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
584 manager} is available, you
585 can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
586 Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
587
588 Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
589 between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
590 same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
591 @code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
592 specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
593 located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
594 @code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
595 Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
596 your goal is to share the store with Nix.
597
598 @node Running the Test Suite
599 @section Running the Test Suite
600
601 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
602 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
603 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
604 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
605 suite, type:
606
607 @example
608 make check
609 @end example
610
611 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
612 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
613 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
614 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
615 cache.
616
617 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
618 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
619
620 @example
621 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
622 @end example
623
624 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
625 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
626 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
627
628 @example
629 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
630 @end example
631
632 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
633 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
634 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
635 your message.
636
637 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
638 GuixSD operating system instances. It can only run on systems where
639 Guix is already installed, using:
640
641 @example
642 make check-system
643 @end example
644
645 @noindent
646 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
647
648 @example
649 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
650 @end example
651
652 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
653 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
654 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
655 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
656 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
657 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
658
659 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
660 all the details.
661
662 @node Setting Up the Daemon
663 @section Setting Up the Daemon
664
665 @cindex daemon
666 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
667 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
668 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
669 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
670 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
671 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
672 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
673
674 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
675 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
676 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
677
678 @menu
679 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
680 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
681 @end menu
682
683 @node Build Environment Setup
684 @subsection Build Environment Setup
685
686 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
687 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
688 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
689 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
690 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
691 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
692 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
693
694 @cindex build users
695 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
696 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
697 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
698 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
699 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
700 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
701 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
702 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
703 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
704 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
705
706 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
707 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
708
709 @c See http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
710 @c for why `-G' is needed.
711 @example
712 # groupadd --system guixbuild
713 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
714 do
715 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
716 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
717 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
718 guixbuilder$i;
719 done
720 @end example
721
722 @noindent
723 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
724 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
725 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
726 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
727 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
728 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
729 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
730
731 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
732 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
733 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
734 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
735 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
736 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
737 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
738 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
739
740 @example
741 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
742 @end example
743
744 @cindex chroot
745 @noindent
746 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
747 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
748 environment contains nothing but:
749
750 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
751 @itemize
752 @item
753 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
754 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
755 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
756 can only be created if the host has them.};
757
758 @item
759 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
760 since a separate PID name space is used;
761
762 @item
763 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
764 user @file{nobody};
765
766 @item
767 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
768
769 @item
770 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
771 @code{127.0.0.1};
772
773 @item
774 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
775 @end itemize
776
777 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
778 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
779 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
780 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
781 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
782 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
783 capture the name of their build tree.
784
785 @vindex http_proxy
786 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
787 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
788 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
789
790 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
791 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
792 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
793 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
794 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
795 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
796 @emph{pure} functions.
797
798
799 @node Daemon Offload Setup
800 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
801
802 @cindex offloading
803 @cindex build hook
804 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload}
805 derivation builds to other machines
806 running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build hook}. When that
807 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
808 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
809 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
810 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
811 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
812 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
813 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
814 build are copied back to the initial machine.
815
816 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
817
818 @example
819 (list (build-machine
820 (name "eightysix.example.org")
821 (system "x86_64-linux")
822 (user "bob")
823 (speed 2.)) ; incredibly fast!
824
825 (build-machine
826 (name "meeps.example.org")
827 (system "mips64el-linux")
828 (user "alice")
829 (private-key
830 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
831 "/.lsh/identity-for-guix"))))
832 @end example
833
834 @noindent
835 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
836 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
837 architecture.
838
839 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
840 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
841 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
842 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
843 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
844 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
845 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
846 detailed below.
847
848 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
849 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
850 builds. The important fields are:
851
852 @table @code
853
854 @item name
855 The host name of the remote machine.
856
857 @item system
858 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
859
860 @item user
861 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
862 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
863 allow non-interactive logins.
864
865 @end table
866
867 A number of optional fields may be specified:
868
869 @table @code
870
871 @item port
872 Port number of SSH server on the machine (default: 22).
873
874 @item private-key
875 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine.
876
877 Currently offloading uses GNU@tie{}lsh as its SSH client
878 (@pxref{Invoking lsh,,, GNU lsh Manual}). Thus, the key file here must
879 be an lsh key file. This may change in the future, though.
880
881 @item parallel-builds
882 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine (1 by
883 default.)
884
885 @item speed
886 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
887 machines with a higher speed factor.
888
889 @item features
890 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
891 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
892 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
893 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
894
895 @end table
896 @end deftp
897
898 The @code{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
899 machines, since offloading works by invoking the @code{guix archive} and
900 @code{guix build} commands. In addition, the Guix modules must be in
901 @code{$GUILE_LOAD_PATH} on the build machine---you can check whether
902 this is the case by running:
903
904 @example
905 lsh build-machine guile -c "'(use-modules (guix config))'"
906 @end example
907
908 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
909 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
910 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
911 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
912 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
913
914 @example
915 # guix archive --generate-key
916 @end example
917
918 @noindent
919 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
920 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
921
922 @example
923 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
924 @end example
925
926 @noindent
927 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
928
929 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
930 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
931 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
932 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
933 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
934
935
936 @node Invoking guix-daemon
937 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
938
939 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
940 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
941 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
942 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
943
944 @example
945 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
946 @end example
947
948 @noindent
949 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
950
951 @cindex chroot
952 @cindex container, build environment
953 @cindex build environment
954 @cindex reproducible builds
955 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
956 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
957 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
958 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
959 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
960 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
961 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
962 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
963 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
964 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
965 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
966
967 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
968 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
969 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable; this directory is shared with
970 the container for the duration of the build. Be aware that using a
971 directory other than @file{/tmp} can affect build results---for example,
972 with a longer directory name, a build process that uses Unix-domain
973 sockets might hit the name length limitation for @code{sun_path}, which
974 it would otherwise not hit.
975
976 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
977 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
978 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
979
980 The following command-line options are supported:
981
982 @table @code
983 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
984 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
985 the Daemon, build users}).
986
987 @item --no-substitutes
988 @cindex substitutes
989 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
990 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
991 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
992
993 By default substitutes are used, unless the client---such as the
994 @command{guix package} command---is explicitly invoked with
995 @code{--no-substitutes}.
996
997 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
998 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
999 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1000
1001 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1002 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1003 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1004 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1005 @indicateurl{https://mirror.hydra.gnu.org https://hydra.gnu.org} is used
1006 (@code{mirror.hydra.gnu.org} is a mirror of @code{hydra.gnu.org}).
1007
1008 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1009 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1010
1011 @cindex build hook
1012 @item --no-build-hook
1013 Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
1014
1015 The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
1016 which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
1017 builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
1018
1019 @item --cache-failures
1020 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1021
1022 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1023 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1024 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1025 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1026
1027 @item --cores=@var{n}
1028 @itemx -c @var{n}
1029 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1030 as available.
1031
1032 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1033 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1034 guix build}).
1035
1036 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1037 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1038 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1039
1040 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1041 @itemx -M @var{n}
1042 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1043 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1044 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1045 Setup}), or simply fail.
1046
1047 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1048 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1049 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1050 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1051 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1052
1053 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1054 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1055 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1056
1057 @item --debug
1058 Produce debugging output.
1059
1060 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1061 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1062 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1063
1064 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1065 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1066
1067 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1068 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1069 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1070 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1071 needs.
1072
1073 @item --disable-chroot
1074 Disable chroot builds.
1075
1076 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1077 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1078 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1079 account.
1080
1081 @item --disable-log-compression
1082 Disable compression of the build logs.
1083
1084 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1085 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1086 them with bzip2 by default. This option disables that.
1087
1088 @item --disable-deduplication
1089 @cindex deduplication
1090 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1091
1092 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1093 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1094 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1095 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1096 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1097 this optimization.
1098
1099 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1100 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1101 derivations.
1102
1103 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1104 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1105 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are GC roots.
1106
1107 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1108 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1109 corresponding to live outputs.
1110
1111 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1112 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1113 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1114 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1115
1116 Note that when both @code{--gc-keep-derivations} and
1117 @code{--gc-keep-outputs} are used, the effect is to keep all the build
1118 prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time
1119 tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of whether these
1120 prerequisites are live. This is convenient for developers since it
1121 saves rebuilds or downloads.
1122
1123 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1124 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1125 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1126
1127 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1128 on the kernel version number.
1129
1130 @item --lose-logs
1131 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1132 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1133
1134 @item --system=@var{system}
1135 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1136 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1137 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1138
1139 @item --listen=@var{socket}
1140 Listen for connections on @var{socket}, the file name of a Unix-domain
1141 socket. The default socket is
1142 @file{@var{localstatedir}/daemon-socket/socket}. This option is only
1143 useful in exceptional circumstances, such as if you need to run several
1144 daemons on the same machine.
1145 @end table
1146
1147
1148 @node Application Setup
1149 @section Application Setup
1150
1151 @cindex foreign distro
1152 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than GuixSD---a
1153 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1154 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1155
1156 @subsection Locales
1157
1158 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1159 @cindex locales, when not on GuixSD
1160 @vindex LOCPATH
1161 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1162 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1163 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1164 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1165 variable:
1166
1167 @example
1168 $ guix package -i glibc-locales
1169 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1170 @end example
1171
1172 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1173 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1174 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1175 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1176
1177 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1178 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1179 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1180
1181 @enumerate
1182 @item
1183 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1184 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1185 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1186 incompatible locale data.
1187
1188 @item
1189 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1190 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1191 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1192 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1193 data in the right format.
1194 @end enumerate
1195
1196 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1197 versions may be incompatible.
1198
1199 @subsection X11 Fonts
1200
1201 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1202 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1203 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1204 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1205 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1206 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1207 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1208
1209 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1210 graphical applications, consider installing
1211 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1212 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1213 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1214 for Chinese languages:
1215
1216 @example
1217 guix package -i font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1218 @end example
1219
1220 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1221 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1222 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1223
1224 @example
1225 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1226 @end example
1227
1228 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1229 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1230
1231 @example
1232 xset +fp ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype
1233 @end example
1234
1235 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1236 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1237
1238 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1239
1240 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1241 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1242
1243 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1244 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1245 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1246 information.
1247
1248 @subsection Emacs Packages
1249
1250 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1251 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1252 sub-directories of
1253 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1254 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1255 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may be not
1256 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1257 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1258 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1259 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1260
1261 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1262 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1263 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1264 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1265 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1266
1267 @c TODO What else?
1268
1269 @c *********************************************************************
1270 @node Package Management
1271 @chapter Package Management
1272
1273 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
1274 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
1275 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
1276 features.
1277
1278 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the package
1279 management tools it provides. Two user interfaces are provided for
1280 routine package management tasks: A command-line interface described below
1281 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix package}}), as well as a visual user
1282 interface in Emacs described in a subsequent chapter (@pxref{Emacs Interface}).
1283
1284 @menu
1285 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
1286 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
1287 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
1288 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
1289 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
1290 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
1291 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
1292 @end menu
1293
1294 @node Features
1295 @section Features
1296
1297 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
1298 own directory---something that resembles
1299 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string
1300 (note that Guix comes with an Emacs extension to shorten those file
1301 names, @pxref{Emacs Prettify}.)
1302
1303 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
1304 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
1305 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
1306 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
1307
1308 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
1309 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
1310 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
1311 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
1312 simply continues to point to
1313 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
1314 coexist on the same system without any interference.
1315
1316 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
1317 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
1318 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
1319
1320 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
1321 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
1322 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
1323 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
1324 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
1325 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
1326
1327 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
1328 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
1329 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
1330 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
1331 system configuration on GuixSD is subject to
1332 transactional upgrades and roll-back
1333 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
1334
1335 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
1336 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
1337 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
1338 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
1339 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
1340 collected.
1341
1342 @cindex reproducibility
1343 @cindex reproducible builds
1344 Finally, Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
1345 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
1346 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
1347 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
1348 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
1349 given package installation matches the current state of their
1350 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
1351 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
1352 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
1353 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
1354
1355 @cindex substitutes
1356 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
1357 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
1358 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
1359 downloads it and unpacks it;
1360 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
1361 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
1362 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
1363 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
1364 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
1365
1366 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
1367 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
1368 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
1369 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
1370 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1371
1372 @node Invoking guix package
1373 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
1374
1375 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
1376 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
1377 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
1378 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
1379 is:
1380
1381 @example
1382 guix package @var{options}
1383 @end example
1384
1385 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
1386 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
1387 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
1388 want to roll back.
1389
1390 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
1391 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
1392
1393 @example
1394 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
1395 @end example
1396
1397 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
1398 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
1399 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
1400 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
1401
1402 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
1403 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
1404 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
1405 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
1406 variable, and so on.
1407 @cindex search paths
1408 If you are not using the Guix System Distribution, consider adding the
1409 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
1410 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
1411 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
1412
1413 @example
1414 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" \
1415 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
1416 @end example
1417
1418 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
1419 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
1420 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
1421 @code{@var{localstatedir}/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
1422 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
1423 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
1424 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
1425 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
1426 package}.
1427
1428 The @var{options} can be among the following:
1429
1430 @table @code
1431
1432 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
1433 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
1434 Install the specified @var{package}s.
1435
1436 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
1437 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
1438 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
1439 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
1440
1441 If no version number is specified, the
1442 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
1443 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
1444 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
1445 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
1446 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
1447 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
1448
1449 @cindex propagated inputs
1450 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
1451 that automatically get installed along with the required package
1452 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
1453 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
1454 package definitions).
1455
1456 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
1457 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
1458 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
1459 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
1460 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
1461 also been explicitly installed by the user.
1462
1463 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
1464 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
1465 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
1466 environment variable definitions are reported here.
1467
1468 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
1469 @itemx -e @var{exp}
1470 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
1471
1472 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
1473 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
1474 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
1475 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
1476
1477 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
1478 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
1479 multiple-output package.
1480
1481 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
1482 @itemx -f @var{file}
1483 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
1484
1485 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
1486 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
1487
1488 @example
1489 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
1490 @end example
1491
1492 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
1493 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
1494 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
1495 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1496
1497 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
1498 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
1499 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
1500
1501 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
1502 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
1503 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
1504 @code{glibc}.
1505
1506 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1507 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1508 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
1509 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
1510 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
1511
1512 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
1513 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
1514 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
1515 pull}).
1516
1517 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1518 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
1519 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
1520 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
1521 substring ``emacs'':
1522
1523 @example
1524 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
1525 @end example
1526
1527 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
1528 @itemx -m @var{file}
1529 @cindex profile declaration
1530 @cindex profile manifest
1531 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
1532 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
1533
1534 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
1535 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
1536 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
1537 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
1538 so on.
1539
1540 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
1541 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
1542 of packages:
1543
1544 @findex packages->manifest
1545 @example
1546 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
1547
1548 (packages->manifest
1549 (list emacs
1550 guile-2.0
1551 ;; Use a specific package output.
1552 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
1553 @end example
1554
1555 @item --roll-back
1556 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
1557 the last transaction.
1558
1559 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
1560 before any other actions.
1561
1562 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
1563 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
1564 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
1565
1566 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
1567 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
1568 generations in a profile is always linear.
1569
1570 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
1571 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
1572 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
1573
1574 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
1575 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
1576 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
1577 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
1578 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
1579
1580 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
1581 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
1582 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
1583 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
1584
1585 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
1586 @cindex search paths
1587 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
1588 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
1589 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
1590 of the installed packages.
1591
1592 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
1593 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
1594 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
1595 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
1596 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
1597 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
1598 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
1599
1600 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
1601 shell:
1602
1603 @example
1604 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
1605 @end example
1606
1607 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
1608 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
1609 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
1610 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
1611
1612 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
1613 of several profiles. Consider this example:
1614
1615 @example
1616 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
1617 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
1618 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
1619 @end example
1620
1621 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
1622 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
1623 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
1624
1625
1626 @item --profile=@var{profile}
1627 @itemx -p @var{profile}
1628 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
1629
1630 @item --verbose
1631 Produce verbose output. In particular, emit the build log of the
1632 environment on the standard error port.
1633
1634 @item --bootstrap
1635 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
1636 useful to distribution developers.
1637
1638 @end table
1639
1640 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
1641 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
1642 availability of packages:
1643
1644 @table @option
1645
1646 @item --search=@var{regexp}
1647 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
1648 @cindex searching for packages
1649 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
1650 @var{regexp}. Print all the metadata of matching packages in
1651 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
1652 GNU recutils manual}).
1653
1654 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
1655 command, for instance:
1656
1657 @example
1658 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version
1659 name: glibc
1660 version: 2.17
1661
1662 name: libgc
1663 version: 7.2alpha6
1664 @end example
1665
1666 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
1667 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
1668
1669 @example
1670 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
1671 name: elfutils
1672
1673 name: gmp
1674 @dots{}
1675 @end example
1676
1677 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s}
1678 flags. For example, the following command returns a list of board
1679 games:
1680
1681 @example
1682 $ guix package -s '\<board\>' -s game | recsel -p name
1683 name: gnubg
1684 @dots{}
1685 @end example
1686
1687 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
1688 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
1689 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
1690 keyboards.
1691
1692 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
1693 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
1694 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
1695
1696 @example
1697 $ guix package -s crypto -s library | \
1698 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
1699 @end example
1700
1701 @noindent
1702 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
1703 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
1704
1705 @item --show=@var{package}
1706 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
1707 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
1708 recutils manual}).
1709
1710 @example
1711 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
1712 name: python
1713 version: 2.7.6
1714
1715 name: python
1716 version: 3.3.5
1717 @end example
1718
1719 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
1720 specific version of it:
1721 @example
1722 $ guix package --show=python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
1723 name: python
1724 version: 3.4.3
1725 @end example
1726
1727
1728
1729 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
1730 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
1731 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
1732 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
1733 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
1734
1735 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1736 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
1737 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
1738 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
1739 the store.
1740
1741 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
1742 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
1743 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
1744 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
1745 installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
1746
1747 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
1748 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
1749 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
1750
1751 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1752 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
1753 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
1754 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
1755 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
1756 shown.
1757
1758 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1759 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
1760 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
1761 location of this package in the store.
1762
1763 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
1764 generations. Valid patterns include:
1765
1766 @itemize
1767 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
1768 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
1769 the first one.
1770
1771 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
1772 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
1773
1774 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
1775 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
1776 a range must be smaller than its end.
1777
1778 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
1779 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
1780 second one.
1781
1782 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
1783 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
1784 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
1785 that are up to 20 days old.
1786 @end itemize
1787
1788 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1789 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
1790 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
1791 one.
1792
1793 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
1794 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
1795 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
1796 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
1797 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
1798
1799 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
1800 zeroth generation is never deleted.
1801
1802 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
1803 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
1804
1805 @end table
1806
1807 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
1808 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
1809 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
1810 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
1811 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
1812 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
1813 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
1814 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
1815
1816
1817 @node Substitutes
1818 @section Substitutes
1819
1820 @cindex substitutes
1821 @cindex pre-built binaries
1822 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
1823 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
1824 server. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they are
1825 substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
1826 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
1827
1828 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
1829 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
1830 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
1831 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
1832
1833 The @code{hydra.gnu.org} server is a front-end to a build farm that
1834 builds packages from the GNU distribution continuously for some
1835 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes (@pxref{Emacs
1836 Hydra}, for information on how to query the continuous integration
1837 server). This is the
1838 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
1839 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
1840 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
1841 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
1842 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
1843 option}).
1844
1845 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS@footnote{For HTTPS access,
1846 the Guile bindings of GnuTLS must be installed. @xref{Requirements}.}
1847 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
1848 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
1849 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
1850 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
1851
1852 @cindex security
1853 @cindex digital signatures
1854 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} or a
1855 mirror thereof, you
1856 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
1857 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
1858 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{hydra.gnu.org} to not
1859 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
1860
1861 This public key is installed along with Guix, in
1862 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
1863 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
1864 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
1865 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
1866 Then, you can run something like this:
1867
1868 @example
1869 # guix archive --authorize < hydra.gnu.org.pub
1870 @end example
1871
1872 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
1873 should change from something like:
1874
1875 @example
1876 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
1877 The following derivations would be built:
1878 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
1879 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
1880 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
1881 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
1882 @dots{}
1883 @end example
1884
1885 @noindent
1886 to something like:
1887
1888 @example
1889 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
1890 The following files would be downloaded:
1891 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
1892 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
1893 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
1894 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
1895 @dots{}
1896 @end example
1897
1898 @noindent
1899 This indicates that substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} are usable and
1900 will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
1901
1902 Guix ignores substitutes that are not signed, or that are not signed by
1903 one of the keys listed in the ACL. It also detects and raises an error
1904 when attempting to use a substitute that has been tampered with.
1905
1906 @vindex http_proxy
1907 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
1908 The @code{http_proxy} environment
1909 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
1910 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
1911 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
1912 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
1913 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
1914
1915 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
1916 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
1917 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
1918 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
1919 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
1920 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
1921
1922 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
1923 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
1924 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
1925 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
1926 build}, and other command-line tools.
1927
1928
1929 @unnumberedsubsec On Trusting Binaries
1930
1931 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
1932 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
1933 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
1934 weaknesses. While using @code{hydra.gnu.org} substitutes can be
1935 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
1936 their own build farm, such that @code{hydra.gnu.org} is less of an
1937 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
1938 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
1939 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
1940
1941 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
1942 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
1943 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
1944 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
1945 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
1946 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
1947 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
1948 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
1949 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
1950 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
1951 @command{guix build --check}}).
1952
1953 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
1954 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
1955 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
1956
1957
1958 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
1959 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
1960
1961 @cindex multiple-output packages
1962 @cindex package outputs
1963
1964 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
1965 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
1966 @command{guix package -i glibc}, one installs the default output of the
1967 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
1968 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
1969 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
1970 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
1971 files.
1972
1973 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
1974 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
1975 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
1976 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
1977 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
1978 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
1979 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
1980
1981 @example
1982 guix package -i glib
1983 @end example
1984
1985 The command to install its documentation is:
1986
1987 @example
1988 guix package -i glib:doc
1989 @end example
1990
1991 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
1992 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
1993 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
1994 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
1995 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
1996 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
1997 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
1998 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
1999 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
2000
2001 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
2002 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
2003 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
2004 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
2005 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
2006 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
2007 guix package}).
2008
2009
2010 @node Invoking guix gc
2011 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
2012
2013 @cindex garbage collector
2014 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
2015 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
2016 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
2017 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
2018 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
2019
2020 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
2021 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
2022 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
2023 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots includes default user
2024 profiles, and may be augmented with @command{guix build --root}, for
2025 example (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
2026
2027 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
2028 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
2029 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
2030 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
2031 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2032
2033 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
2034 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
2035 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
2036 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
2037 options are as follows:
2038
2039 @table @code
2040 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
2041 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
2042 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
2043 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
2044 specified.
2045
2046 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
2047 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
2048 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
2049 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
2050
2051 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
2052
2053 @item --free-space=@var{free}
2054 @itemx -F @var{free}
2055 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
2056 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
2057 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
2058
2059 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
2060 nothing and exit immediately.
2061
2062 @item --delete
2063 @itemx -d
2064 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
2065 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
2066 they are still live.
2067
2068 @item --list-failures
2069 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
2070
2071 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
2072 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2073 @option{--cache-failures}}).
2074
2075 @item --clear-failures
2076 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
2077
2078 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
2079 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
2080
2081 @item --list-dead
2082 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
2083 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
2084
2085 @item --list-live
2086 Show the list of live store files and directories.
2087
2088 @end table
2089
2090 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
2091
2092 @table @code
2093
2094 @item --references
2095 @itemx --referrers
2096 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
2097 as arguments.
2098
2099 @item --requisites
2100 @itemx -R
2101 @cindex closure
2102 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
2103 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
2104 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
2105 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
2106
2107 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
2108 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
2109 the graph of references.
2110
2111 @end table
2112
2113 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
2114 store and to control disk usage.
2115
2116 @table @option
2117
2118 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
2119 @cindex integrity, of the store
2120 @cindex integrity checking
2121 Verify the integrity of the store.
2122
2123 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
2124 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
2125
2126 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
2127 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
2128
2129 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
2130 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
2131 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
2132 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
2133 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
2134
2135 @cindex repairing the store
2136 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
2137 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
2138 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
2139 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
2140 system administrator.
2141
2142 @item --optimize
2143 @cindex deduplication
2144 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
2145 @dfn{deduplication}.
2146
2147 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
2148 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
2149 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
2150 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
2151 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
2152
2153 @end table
2154
2155 @node Invoking guix pull
2156 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
2157
2158 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
2159 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
2160 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
2161 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
2162 descriptions, and deploys it.
2163
2164 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
2165 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
2166 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
2167 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
2168 become available.
2169
2170 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
2171 effect is limited to the user who run @command{guix pull}. For
2172 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
2173 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
2174 versa@footnote{Under the hood, @command{guix pull} updates the
2175 @file{~/.config/guix/latest} symbolic link to point to the latest Guix,
2176 and the @command{guix} command loads code from there.}.
2177
2178 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
2179 but it supports the following options:
2180
2181 @table @code
2182 @item --verbose
2183 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
2184
2185 @item --url=@var{url}
2186 Download the source tarball of Guix from @var{url}.
2187
2188 By default, the tarball is taken from its canonical address at
2189 @code{gnu.org}, for the stable branch of Guix.
2190
2191 @item --bootstrap
2192 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
2193 useful to Guix developers.
2194 @end table
2195
2196
2197 @node Invoking guix archive
2198 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
2199
2200 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
2201 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them.
2202 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
2203 to the store on another machine.
2204
2205 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
2206
2207 @example
2208 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
2209 @end example
2210
2211 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
2212 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2213 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
2214 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
2215 output of @code{emacs}:
2216
2217 @example
2218 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
2219 @end example
2220
2221 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
2222 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
2223 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
2224
2225 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
2226 one would run:
2227
2228 @example
2229 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
2230 @end example
2231
2232 @noindent
2233 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
2234 to another like this:
2235
2236 @example
2237 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
2238 ssh the-machine guix-archive --import
2239 @end example
2240
2241 @noindent
2242 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
2243 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
2244 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
2245 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
2246 items are missing from the target store.
2247
2248 Archives are stored in the ``Nix archive'' or ``Nar'' format, which is
2249 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with a few noteworthy differences
2250 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
2251 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the Nar format only mentions
2252 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
2253 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
2254 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
2255 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
2256 deterministic.
2257
2258 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
2259 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
2260 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
2261 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
2262 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
2263
2264 The main options are:
2265
2266 @table @code
2267 @item --export
2268 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
2269 resulting archive to the standard output.
2270
2271 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
2272 @code{--recursive} is passed.
2273
2274 @item -r
2275 @itemx --recursive
2276 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
2277 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
2278 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
2279 of the exported store items.
2280
2281 @item --import
2282 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
2283 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
2284 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
2285 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
2286
2287 @item --missing
2288 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
2289 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
2290 the store.
2291
2292 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
2293 @cindex signing, archives
2294 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
2295 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
2296 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
2297 generate the key pair.
2298
2299 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
2300 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
2301 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
2302 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
2303 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
2304 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
2305 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
2306 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
2307 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
2308
2309 @item --authorize
2310 @cindex authorizing, archives
2311 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
2312 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
2313 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
2314
2315 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
2316 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
2317 @url{http://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
2318 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
2319 @url{http://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
2320 (SPKI)}.
2321
2322 @item --extract=@var{directory}
2323 @itemx -x @var{directory}
2324 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
2325 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
2326 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
2327
2328 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
2329 served by @code{hydra.gnu.org} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
2330
2331 @example
2332 $ wget -O - \
2333 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
2334 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
2335 @end example
2336
2337 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
2338 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
2339 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
2340 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
2341 unsafe.
2342
2343 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
2344 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
2345
2346 @end table
2347
2348 @c *********************************************************************
2349 @include emacs.texi
2350
2351 @c *********************************************************************
2352 @node Programming Interface
2353 @chapter Programming Interface
2354
2355 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
2356 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
2357 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
2358 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
2359 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
2360 turned into concrete build actions.
2361
2362 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
2363 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
2364 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
2365 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
2366 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
2367
2368 @cindex derivation
2369 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
2370 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
2371 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
2372 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
2373 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
2374 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
2375 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
2376
2377 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
2378 package definitions.
2379
2380 @menu
2381 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
2382 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
2383 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
2384 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
2385 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
2386 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
2387 @end menu
2388
2389 @node Defining Packages
2390 @section Defining Packages
2391
2392 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
2393 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
2394 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
2395 package looks like this:
2396
2397 @example
2398 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
2399 #:use-module (guix packages)
2400 #:use-module (guix download)
2401 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
2402 #:use-module (guix licenses)
2403 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
2404
2405 (define-public hello
2406 (package
2407 (name "hello")
2408 (version "2.10")
2409 (source (origin
2410 (method url-fetch)
2411 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
2412 ".tar.gz"))
2413 (sha256
2414 (base32
2415 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
2416 (build-system gnu-build-system)
2417 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
2418 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
2419 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
2420 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
2421 (home-page "http://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
2422 (license gpl3+)))
2423 @end example
2424
2425 @noindent
2426 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
2427 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
2428 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
2429 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
2430 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
2431 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
2432 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
2433
2434 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
2435 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
2436 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
2437
2438 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
2439 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
2440 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
2441 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
2442 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2443
2444 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
2445
2446 @itemize
2447 @item
2448 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
2449 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
2450 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
2451 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
2452
2453 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
2454 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
2455
2456 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
2457 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
2458 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
2459 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
2460 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
2461 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
2462
2463 @cindex patches
2464 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
2465 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
2466 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
2467
2468 @item
2469 @cindex GNU Build System
2470 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
2471 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
2472 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
2473 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
2474 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
2475
2476 @item
2477 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
2478 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
2479 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
2480 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
2481
2482 @cindex quote
2483 @cindex quoting
2484 @findex '
2485 @findex quote
2486 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
2487 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
2488 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
2489 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
2490 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
2491 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
2492 Manual}).
2493
2494 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
2495 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
2496 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
2497 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
2498 Reference Manual}).
2499
2500 @item
2501 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
2502 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
2503 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
2504 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
2505
2506 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
2507 @findex `
2508 @findex quasiquote
2509 @cindex comma (unquote)
2510 @findex ,
2511 @findex unquote
2512 @findex ,@@
2513 @findex unquote-splicing
2514 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
2515 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
2516 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
2517 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
2518 Reference Manual}).
2519
2520 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
2521 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
2522 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
2523
2524 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
2525 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
2526 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
2527 @end itemize
2528
2529 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
2530
2531 Once a package definition is in place, the
2532 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
2533 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). You can easily jump back to the
2534 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
2535 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
2536 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
2537 more information on how to test package definitions, and
2538 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
2539 for style conformance.
2540
2541 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
2542 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
2543 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
2544
2545 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
2546 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
2547 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
2548 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
2549 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
2550
2551 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
2552 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
2553 (@pxref{Derivations}).
2554
2555 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
2556 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
2557 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
2558 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
2559 (@pxref{The Store}).
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @noindent
2563 @cindex cross-compilation
2564 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
2565 package for some other system:
2566
2567 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
2568 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
2569 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
2570 @var{system} to @var{target}.
2571
2572 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
2573 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
2574 (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU configuration triplets,, configure, GNU
2575 Configure and Build System}).
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @cindex package transformations
2579 @cindex input rewriting
2580 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
2581 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
2582 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
2583 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
2584
2585 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
2586 [@var{rewrite-name}]
2587 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
2588 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
2589 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
2590 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
2591 is the replacement.
2592
2593 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
2594 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
2595 @end deffn
2596
2597 @noindent
2598 Consider this example:
2599
2600 @example
2601 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
2602 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
2603 ;; recursively.
2604 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
2605
2606 (define git-with-libressl
2607 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
2608 @end example
2609
2610 @noindent
2611 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
2612 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
2613 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
2614 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
2615 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
2616
2617 @menu
2618 * package Reference :: The package data type.
2619 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
2620 @end menu
2621
2622
2623 @node package Reference
2624 @subsection @code{package} Reference
2625
2626 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
2627 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2628
2629 @deftp {Data Type} package
2630 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
2631
2632 @table @asis
2633 @item @code{name}
2634 The name of the package, as a string.
2635
2636 @item @code{version}
2637 The version of the package, as a string.
2638
2639 @item @code{source}
2640 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
2641 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
2642 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
2643 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
2644 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
2645 @code{local-file}}).
2646
2647 @item @code{build-system}
2648 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
2649 Systems}).
2650
2651 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
2652 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
2653 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
2654
2655 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2656 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2657 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2658 @cindex inputs, of packages
2659 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
2660 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
2661 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
2662 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
2663 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
2664 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
2665 inputs:
2666
2667 @example
2668 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
2669 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
2670 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
2671 @end example
2672
2673 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
2674 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
2675 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
2676 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
2677 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
2678 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
2679
2680 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
2681 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
2682 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
2683 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
2684
2685 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
2686 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
2687 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
2688 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
2689 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
2690 propagated inputs.)
2691
2692 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
2693 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
2694 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
2695
2696 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
2697 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
2698 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, GHC, and
2699 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
2700 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
2701 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
2702
2703 @item @code{self-native-input?} (default: @code{#f})
2704 This is a Boolean field telling whether the package should use itself as
2705 a native input when cross-compiling.
2706
2707 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
2708 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
2709 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
2710
2711 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2712 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2713 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
2714 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
2715
2716 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
2717 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
2718 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
2719 for details.
2720
2721 @item @code{synopsis}
2722 A one-line description of the package.
2723
2724 @item @code{description}
2725 A more elaborate description of the package.
2726
2727 @item @code{license}
2728 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
2729 or a list of such values.
2730
2731 @item @code{home-page}
2732 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
2733
2734 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
2735 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
2736 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
2737
2738 @item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
2739 The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
2740
2741 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
2742 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
2743 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
2744 automatically corrected.
2745 @end table
2746 @end deftp
2747
2748
2749 @node origin Reference
2750 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
2751
2752 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
2753 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2754
2755 @deftp {Data Type} origin
2756 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
2757
2758 @table @asis
2759 @item @code{uri}
2760 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
2761 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
2762 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
2763 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
2764
2765 @item @code{method}
2766 A procedure that handles the URI.
2767
2768 Examples include:
2769
2770 @table @asis
2771 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
2772 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
2773 @code{uri} field;
2774
2775 @vindex git-fetch
2776 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
2777 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
2778 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
2779 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
2780
2781 @example
2782 (git-reference
2783 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
2784 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
2785 @end example
2786 @end table
2787
2788 @item @code{sha256}
2789 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
2790 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
2791 base-32 string.
2792
2793 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
2794 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
2795 guix hash}).
2796
2797 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
2798 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
2799 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
2800 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
2801 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
2802 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
2803
2804 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
2805 A list of file names containing patches to be applied to the source.
2806
2807 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
2808 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
2809 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
2810 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
2811
2812 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
2813 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
2814 command.
2815
2816 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
2817 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
2818 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
2819 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
2820
2821 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
2822 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
2823 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
2824
2825 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
2826 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
2827 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
2828 @end table
2829 @end deftp
2830
2831
2832 @node Build Systems
2833 @section Build Systems
2834
2835 @cindex build system
2836 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
2837 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
2838 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
2839 dependencies of that build procedure.
2840
2841 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
2842 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
2843 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
2844
2845 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
2846 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
2847 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
2848 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
2849 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
2850 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
2851 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
2852
2853 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
2854 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
2855 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
2856 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
2857 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
2858 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
2859 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
2860
2861 The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
2862 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
2863 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
2864
2865 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
2866 @var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
2867 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
2868 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
2869
2870 @cindex build phases
2871 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
2872 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
2873 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
2874 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
2875 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
2876 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
2877
2878 @table @code
2879 @item unpack
2880 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
2881 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
2882 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
2883
2884 @item patch-source-shebangs
2885 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
2886 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
2887 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
2888
2889 @item configure
2890 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
2891 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
2892 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
2893
2894 @item build
2895 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
2896 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
2897 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
2898
2899 @item check
2900 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
2901 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
2902 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
2903 check -j}.
2904
2905 @item install
2906 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
2907
2908 @item patch-shebangs
2909 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
2910
2911 @item strip
2912 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
2913 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
2914 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
2915 @end table
2916
2917 @vindex %standard-phases
2918 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
2919 @var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
2920 @var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
2921 procedure implements the actual phase.
2922
2923 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
2924 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
2925
2926 @example
2927 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
2928 @end example
2929
2930 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
2931 @code{configure} phase.
2932
2933 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
2934 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
2935 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
2936 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
2937 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
2938 have to mention them.
2939 @end defvr
2940
2941 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
2942 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
2943 of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
2944 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
2945 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
2946
2947 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
2948 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
2949 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
2950 @url{http://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
2951
2952 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
2953 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
2954 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
2955 parameters, respectively.
2956
2957 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
2958 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
2959 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
2960 archive.
2961
2962 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
2963 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
2964 ``jar'' task will be run.
2965
2966 @end defvr
2967
2968 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
2969 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
2970 implements the build procedure for packages using the
2971 @url{http://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
2972
2973 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
2974 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
2975 parameter.
2976
2977 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
2978 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
2979 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
2980 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
2981 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
2982 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
2983 @end defvr
2984
2985 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
2986 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
2987 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
2988
2989 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
2990 @var{gnu-build-system}:
2991
2992 @table @code
2993 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
2994 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
2995 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
2996 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
2997 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
2998 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
2999 environment variables.
3000
3001 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
3002 process by listing their names in the
3003 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
3004 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
3005 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
3006 GLib and GTK+.
3007
3008 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
3009 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
3010 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
3011 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
3012 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
3013 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
3014 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
3015 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
3016 @end table
3017
3018 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
3019 @end defvr
3020
3021 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
3022 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
3023 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
3024 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
3025 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
3026
3027 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
3028 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
3029 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
3030
3031 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
3032 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
3033 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
3034 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
3035 interpreter version.
3036 @end defvr
3037
3038 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
3039 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
3040 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
3041 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
3042 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
3043 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
3044 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
3045 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
3046 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
3047 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
3048 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
3049 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
3050
3051 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
3052 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
3053 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
3054
3055 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
3056 @end defvr
3057
3058 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
3059 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
3060 implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://r-project.org, R}
3061 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
3062 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
3063 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
3064 are run after installation using the R function
3065 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
3066 @end defvr
3067
3068 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
3069 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
3070 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
3071 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
3072
3073 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
3074 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
3075 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
3076 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
3077 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
3078 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
3079 a traditional source release tarball.
3080
3081 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
3082 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
3083 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
3084 @end defvr
3085
3086 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
3087 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
3088 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
3089 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
3090 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
3091 script.
3092
3093 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
3094 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
3095 @code{#:python} parameter.
3096 @end defvr
3097
3098 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
3099 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
3100 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
3101 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
3102 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
3103 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
3104 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
3105 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
3106 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
3107 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
3108 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
3109 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
3110 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
3111 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
3112
3113 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
3114 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
3115 @end defvr
3116
3117 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
3118 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
3119 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
3120 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
3121
3122 It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
3123 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
3124 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
3125 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
3126 package is installed in its own directory under
3127 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
3128 @end defvr
3129
3130 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
3131 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
3132 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
3133 and does not have a notion of build phases.
3134
3135 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
3136 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
3137
3138 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
3139 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
3140 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
3141 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
3142 @end defvr
3143
3144 @node The Store
3145 @section The Store
3146
3147 @cindex store
3148 @cindex store items
3149 @cindex store paths
3150
3151 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
3152 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
3153 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
3154 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
3155 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
3156 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
3157 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
3158 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
3159 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
3160
3161 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
3162 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
3163 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
3164 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
3165
3166 @quotation Note
3167 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
3168 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
3169 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
3170
3171 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
3172 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
3173 accidental modifications.
3174 @end quotation
3175
3176 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
3177 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below.
3178
3179 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{file}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
3180 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{file}. When
3181 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
3182 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
3183 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
3184
3185 @var{file} defaults to @var{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
3186 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
3187 @end deffn
3188
3189 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
3190 Close the connection to @var{server}.
3191 @end deffn
3192
3193 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
3194 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
3195 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
3196 @end defvr
3197
3198 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
3199 argument.
3200
3201 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
3202 @cindex invalid store items
3203 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
3204 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
3205 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
3206 build.)
3207
3208 A @code{&nix-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
3209 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
3210 @end deffn
3211
3212 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
3213 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
3214 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
3215 resulting store path.
3216 @end deffn
3217
3218 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{server} @var{derivations}
3219 Build @var{derivations} (a list of @code{<derivation>} objects or
3220 derivation paths), and return when the worker is done building them.
3221 Return @code{#t} on success.
3222 @end deffn
3223
3224 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
3225 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
3226 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
3227 Store Monad}).
3228
3229 @c FIXME
3230 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
3231
3232 @node Derivations
3233 @section Derivations
3234
3235 @cindex derivations
3236 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
3237 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
3238 following pieces of information:
3239
3240 @itemize
3241 @item
3242 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
3243 directory in the store, but may produce more.
3244
3245 @item
3246 The inputs of the derivations, which may be other derivations or plain
3247 files in the store (patches, build scripts, etc.)
3248
3249 @item
3250 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
3251
3252 @item
3253 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
3254 to be passed.
3255
3256 @item
3257 A list of environment variables to be defined.
3258
3259 @end itemize
3260
3261 @cindex derivation path
3262 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
3263 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
3264 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
3265 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
3266 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
3267 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
3268 Store}).
3269
3270 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
3271 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
3272 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
3273 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
3274
3275 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
3276 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3277 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
3278 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
3279 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
3280 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
3281 [#:substitutable? #t]
3282 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
3283 @code{<derivation>} object.
3284
3285 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
3286 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
3287 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
3288 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
3289 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
3290 containing this output.
3291
3292 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
3293 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
3294 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
3295 a simple text format.
3296
3297 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
3298 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
3299 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
3300 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
3301
3302 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
3303 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
3304 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
3305 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
3306 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
3307 derivations that download files.
3308
3309 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
3310 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
3311 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
3312 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
3313
3314 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
3315 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
3316 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
3317 host CPU instruction set.
3318 @end deffn
3319
3320 @noindent
3321 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
3322 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
3323 to a Bash executable in the store:
3324
3325 @lisp
3326 (use-modules (guix utils)
3327 (guix store)
3328 (guix derivations))
3329
3330 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
3331 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
3332 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
3333 (derivation store "foo"
3334 bash `("-e" ,builder)
3335 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
3336 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
3337 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
3338 @end lisp
3339
3340 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
3341 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
3342 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
3343 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
3344 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
3345
3346 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
3347 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
3348 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
3349 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
3350
3351 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
3352 @var{name} @var{exp} @
3353 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
3354 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3355 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
3356 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
3357 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
3358 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
3359 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
3360 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
3361 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
3362 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
3363 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
3364 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
3365 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
3366 gnu-build-system))}.
3367
3368 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
3369 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
3370 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
3371 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
3372 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
3373 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
3374 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
3375
3376 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
3377 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
3378 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
3379
3380 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
3381 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
3382 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
3383 @var{substitutable?}.
3384 @end deffn
3385
3386 @noindent
3387 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
3388 containing one file:
3389
3390 @lisp
3391 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
3392 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
3393 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
3394 (lambda (p)
3395 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
3396 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
3397
3398 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
3399 @end lisp
3400
3401
3402 @node The Store Monad
3403 @section The Store Monad
3404
3405 @cindex monad
3406
3407 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
3408 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
3409 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
3410 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
3411
3412 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
3413 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
3414 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
3415 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
3416 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
3417
3418 @cindex monadic values
3419 @cindex monadic functions
3420 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
3421 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
3422 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
3423 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
3424 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
3425 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
3426 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
3427 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
3428 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
3429
3430 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
3431
3432 @example
3433 (define (sh-symlink store)
3434 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
3435 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
3436 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
3437 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
3438 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
3439 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
3440 @end example
3441
3442 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
3443 as a monadic function:
3444
3445 @example
3446 (define (sh-symlink)
3447 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
3448 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
3449 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3450 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
3451 #$output))))
3452 @end example
3453
3454 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
3455 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
3456 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
3457 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
3458 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
3459
3460 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
3461 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
3462 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
3463
3464 @example
3465 (define (sh-symlink)
3466 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3467 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
3468 #$output)))
3469 @end example
3470
3471 @c See
3472 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
3473 @c for the funny quote.
3474 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
3475 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
3476 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
3477 @code{run-with-store}:
3478
3479 @example
3480 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
3481 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
3482 @end example
3483
3484 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
3485 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
3486 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
3487 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
3488
3489 @example
3490 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
3491 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3492 @end example
3493
3494 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
3495 automatically run through the store:
3496
3497 @example
3498 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
3499 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
3500 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3501 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
3502 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
3503 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
3504 scheme@@(guile-user)>
3505 @end example
3506
3507 @noindent
3508 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
3509 @code{store-monad} REPL.
3510
3511 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
3512 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
3513
3514 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
3515 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
3516 in @var{monad}.
3517 @end deffn
3518
3519 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
3520 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
3521 @end deffn
3522
3523 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
3524 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
3525 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
3526 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
3527 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
3528 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
3529 in this example:
3530
3531 @example
3532 (run-with-state
3533 (with-monad %state-monad
3534 (>>= (return 1)
3535 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
3536 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
3537 'some-state)
3538
3539 @result{} 4
3540 @result{} some-state
3541 @end example
3542 @end deffn
3543
3544 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3545 @var{body} ...
3546 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3547 @var{body} ...
3548 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
3549 @var{body}. The form (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the
3550 ``normal'' value @var{val}, as per @code{let}.
3551
3552 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
3553 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3554 @end deffn
3555
3556 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
3557 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
3558 returning the result of the last expression.
3559
3560 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
3561 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
3562 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
3563 @end deffn
3564
3565 @cindex state monad
3566 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
3567 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
3568 monadic procedure calls.
3569
3570 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
3571 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
3572 the state that is threaded.
3573
3574 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
3575 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
3576 increments the current state value:
3577
3578 @example
3579 (define (square x)
3580 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
3581 (mbegin %state-monad
3582 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
3583 (return (* x x)))))
3584
3585 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
3586 @result{} (0 1 4)
3587 @result{} 3
3588 @end example
3589
3590 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
3591 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
3592 @end defvr
3593
3594 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
3595 Return the current state as a monadic value.
3596 @end deffn
3597
3598 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
3599 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
3600 monadic value.
3601 @end deffn
3602
3603 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
3604 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
3605 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
3606 @end deffn
3607
3608 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
3609 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
3610 The state is assumed to be a list.
3611 @end deffn
3612
3613 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
3614 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
3615 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
3616 @end deffn
3617
3618 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
3619 store)} module, is as follows.
3620
3621 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
3622 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
3623
3624 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
3625 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
3626 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
3627 @end defvr
3628
3629 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
3630 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
3631 open store connection.
3632 @end deffn
3633
3634 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
3635 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
3636 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
3637 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
3638 @end deffn
3639
3640 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3641 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
3642 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
3643 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
3644 @var{name} is omitted.
3645
3646 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
3647 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
3648 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
3649
3650 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
3651 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
3652 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
3653 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
3654
3655 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
3656
3657 @example
3658 (run-with-store (open-connection)
3659 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
3660 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
3661 (return (list a b))))
3662
3663 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
3664 @end example
3665
3666 @end deffn
3667
3668 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
3669 monadic procedures:
3670
3671 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
3672 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
3673 [#:output "out"]
3674 Return as a monadic
3675 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
3676 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
3677 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
3678 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
3679 @end deffn
3680
3681 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
3682 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
3683 @var{target} [@var{system}]
3684 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
3685 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3686 @end deffn
3687
3688
3689 @node G-Expressions
3690 @section G-Expressions
3691
3692 @cindex G-expression
3693 @cindex build code quoting
3694 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
3695 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
3696 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
3697 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
3698 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
3699
3700 @cindex strata of code
3701 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
3702 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
3703 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
3704 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
3705 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
3706 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
3707 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
3708 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
3709 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
3710 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
3711 @command{make}, etc.
3712
3713 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
3714 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
3715 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
3716 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
3717 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
3718 expressions.
3719
3720 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
3721 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
3722 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
3723 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
3724 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
3725 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
3726 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
3727 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
3728
3729 @itemize
3730 @item
3731 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
3732 processes.
3733
3734 @item
3735 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
3736 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
3737 introduced.
3738
3739 @item
3740 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
3741 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
3742 processes that use them.
3743 @end itemize
3744
3745 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
3746 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
3747 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
3748 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
3749 such that these objects can also be inserted
3750 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
3751 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
3752 add files to the store and to refer to them in
3753 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
3754 below.)
3755
3756 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
3757
3758 @example
3759 (define build-exp
3760 #~(begin
3761 (mkdir #$output)
3762 (chdir #$output)
3763 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
3764 "list-files")))
3765 @end example
3766
3767 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
3768 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
3769 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
3770
3771 @example
3772 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
3773 @end example
3774
3775 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
3776 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
3777 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
3778 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
3779 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
3780 output of the derivation.
3781
3782 @cindex cross compilation
3783 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
3784 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
3785 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
3786 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
3787 native package build:
3788
3789 @example
3790 (gexp->derivation "vi"
3791 #~(begin
3792 (mkdir #$output)
3793 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
3794 "-s"
3795 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
3796 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
3797 #:target "mips64el-linux-gnu")
3798 @end example
3799
3800 @noindent
3801 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
3802 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
3803 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
3804
3805 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
3806 @findex with-imported-modules
3807 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
3808 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
3809 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
3810 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
3811
3812 @example
3813 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
3814 #~(begin
3815 (use-modules (guix build utils))
3816 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
3817 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
3818 #~(begin
3819 #$build
3820 (display "success!\n")
3821 #t)))
3822 @end example
3823
3824 @noindent
3825 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
3826 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
3827 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
3828
3829 @cindex module closure
3830 @findex source-module-closure
3831 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
3832 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
3833 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
3834 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
3835 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
3836 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
3837
3838 @example
3839 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
3840
3841 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
3842 '((guix build utils)
3843 (gnu build vm)))
3844 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
3845 #~(begin
3846 (use-modules (guix build utils)
3847 (gnu build vm))
3848 @dots{})))
3849 @end example
3850
3851 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
3852
3853 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
3854 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
3855 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
3856 or more of the following forms:
3857
3858 @table @code
3859 @item #$@var{obj}
3860 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
3861 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
3862 supported types, for example a package or a
3863 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
3864 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
3865
3866 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
3867 objects are substituted similarly.
3868
3869 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
3870 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
3871
3872 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
3873
3874 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
3875 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
3876 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
3877 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
3878 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
3879
3880 @item #+@var{obj}
3881 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
3882 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
3883 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
3884 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
3885 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
3886
3887 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
3888 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
3889 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
3890 output when @var{output} is omitted.
3891
3892 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
3893
3894 @item #$@@@var{lst}
3895 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
3896 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
3897 containing list.
3898
3899 @item #+@@@var{lst}
3900 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
3901 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
3902 @var{lst}.
3903
3904 @end table
3905
3906 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
3907 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
3908 @end deffn
3909
3910 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
3911 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
3912 in their execution environment. @var{modules} must be a list of Guile
3913 module names, such as @code{'((guix build utils) (guix build gremlin))}.
3914
3915 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
3916 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
3917 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
3918 @end deffn
3919
3920 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
3921 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
3922 @end deffn
3923
3924 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
3925 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
3926 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
3927 information about monads.)
3928
3929 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
3930 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
3931 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3932 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
3933 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
3934 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
3935 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
3936 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
3937 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
3938 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
3939 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
3940 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
3941 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
3942 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
3943 to by @var{exp}.
3944
3945 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
3946 Its meaning is to
3947 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
3948 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
3949 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
3950 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
3951 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
3952
3953 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
3954 applicable.
3955
3956 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
3957 following forms:
3958
3959 @example
3960 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
3961 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
3962 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
3963 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
3964 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
3965 @end example
3966
3967 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
3968 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
3969 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
3970 text format.
3971
3972 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
3973 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
3974 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
3975 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
3976 referenced by the outputs.
3977
3978 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
3979 @end deffn
3980
3981 @cindex file-like objects
3982 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
3983 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
3984 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
3985 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
3986
3987 @example
3988 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
3989 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
3990 @end example
3991
3992 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
3993 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
3994 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
3995 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
3996 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
3997 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
3998 content is directly passed as a string.
3999
4000 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
4001 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
4002 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
4003 object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
4004 up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
4005 the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
4006
4007 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
4008 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
4009 permission bits are kept.
4010
4011 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
4012 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
4013 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
4014 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
4015
4016 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
4017 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
4018 @end deffn
4019
4020 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
4021 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
4022 @var{content} (a string) to be added to the store.
4023
4024 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
4025 @end deffn
4026
4027 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
4028 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
4029 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
4030 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
4031 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
4032
4033 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
4034 @end deffn
4035
4036 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp}
4037 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
4038 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
4039
4040 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
4041 command:
4042
4043 @example
4044 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
4045
4046 (gexp->script "list-files"
4047 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
4048 "ls"))
4049 @end example
4050
4051 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
4052 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
4053 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
4054
4055 @example
4056 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
4057 !#
4058 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
4059 @end example
4060 @end deffn
4061
4062 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
4063 [#:guile #f]
4064 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
4065 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
4066 script.
4067
4068 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
4069 @end deffn
4070
4071 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
4072 [#:set-load-path? #t]
4073 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
4074 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
4075 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
4076 @var{exp}'s imported modules.
4077
4078 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
4079 or a subset thereof.
4080 @end deffn
4081
4082 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp}
4083 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
4084 @var{exp}.
4085
4086 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
4087 @end deffn
4088
4089 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
4090 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
4091 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
4092 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
4093 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
4094 references to all these.
4095
4096 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
4097 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
4098 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
4099 like this:
4100
4101 @example
4102 (define (profile.sh)
4103 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
4104 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
4105 (text-file* "profile.sh"
4106 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
4107 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
4108 @end example
4109
4110 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
4111 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
4112 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
4113 @end deffn
4114
4115 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
4116 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
4117 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
4118 as in:
4119
4120 @example
4121 (mixed-text-file "profile"
4122 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
4123 @end example
4124
4125 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
4126 @end deffn
4127
4128 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
4129 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
4130 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
4131 @var{suffix} is a string.
4132
4133 As an example, consider this gexp:
4134
4135 @example
4136 (gexp->script "run-uname"
4137 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
4138 "/bin/uname")))
4139 @end example
4140
4141 The same effect could be achieved with:
4142
4143 @example
4144 (gexp->script "run-uname"
4145 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
4146 "/bin/uname")))
4147 @end example
4148
4149 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
4150 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
4151 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
4152 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
4153 @end deffn
4154
4155
4156 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
4157 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
4158 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
4159 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
4160
4161 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
4162 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
4163 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
4164 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
4165 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
4166
4167 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
4168 [#:target #f]
4169 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
4170 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
4171 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
4172 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
4173 @end deffn
4174
4175
4176 @c *********************************************************************
4177 @node Utilities
4178 @chapter Utilities
4179
4180 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
4181 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
4182 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
4183 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
4184
4185 @menu
4186 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
4187 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
4188 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
4189 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
4190 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
4191 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
4192 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
4193 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
4194 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
4195 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4196 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
4197 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
4198 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
4199 @end menu
4200
4201 @node Invoking guix build
4202 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
4203
4204 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
4205 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
4206 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
4207 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
4208 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
4209
4210 The general syntax is:
4211
4212 @example
4213 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
4214 @end example
4215
4216 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
4217 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
4218 resulting directories:
4219
4220 @example
4221 guix build emacs guile
4222 @end example
4223
4224 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
4225
4226 @example
4227 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
4228 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
4229 @end example
4230
4231 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
4232 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
4233 @code{coreutils-8.20}, or a derivation such as
4234 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
4235 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
4236 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
4237
4238 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
4239 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
4240 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
4241 needed.
4242
4243 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
4244 described in the subsections below.
4245
4246 @menu
4247 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
4248 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
4249 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
4250 @end menu
4251
4252 @node Common Build Options
4253 @subsection Common Build Options
4254
4255 A number of options that control the build process are common to
4256 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
4257 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
4258 following:
4259
4260 @table @code
4261
4262 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
4263 @itemx -L @var{directory}
4264 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
4265 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
4266
4267 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
4268 the command-line tools.
4269
4270 @item --keep-failed
4271 @itemx -K
4272 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
4273 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
4274 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
4275
4276 @item --keep-going
4277 @itemx -k
4278 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
4279 all the builds have either completed or failed.
4280
4281 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
4282 derivations has failed.
4283
4284 @item --dry-run
4285 @itemx -n
4286 Do not build the derivations.
4287
4288 @item --fallback
4289 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
4290 packages locally.
4291
4292 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
4293 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
4294 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
4295 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
4296 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
4297
4298 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
4299 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
4300 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
4301
4302 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
4303 disabled.
4304
4305 @item --no-substitutes
4306 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
4307 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
4308 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
4309
4310 @item --no-grafts
4311 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
4312 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
4313 information on grafts.
4314
4315 @item --rounds=@var{n}
4316 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
4317 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
4318
4319 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
4320 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
4321 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
4322 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
4323
4324 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
4325 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
4326 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
4327 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
4328 the two results.
4329
4330 @item --no-build-hook
4331 Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the ``build hook'' of the daemon
4332 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
4333 instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
4334
4335 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
4336 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
4337 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
4338
4339 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
4340 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
4341 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
4342
4343 By default there is no timeout. This behavior can be restored with
4344 @code{--timeout=0}.
4345
4346 @item --verbosity=@var{level}
4347 Use the given verbosity level. @var{level} must be an integer between 0
4348 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of 4 or more
4349 may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
4350
4351 @item --cores=@var{n}
4352 @itemx -c @var{n}
4353 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
4354 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
4355
4356 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
4357 @itemx -M @var{n}
4358 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
4359 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
4360 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
4361
4362 @end table
4363
4364 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
4365 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
4366 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
4367 derivations)} module.
4368
4369 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
4370 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
4371 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
4372
4373 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
4374 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
4375 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
4376 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
4377 below:
4378
4379 @example
4380 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
4381 @end example
4382
4383 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
4384 the parsed command-line options.
4385 @end defvr
4386
4387
4388 @node Package Transformation Options
4389 @subsection Package Transformation Options
4390
4391 @cindex package variants
4392 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
4393 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
4394 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
4395 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
4396 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
4397 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
4398 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4399
4400 @table @code
4401
4402 @item --with-source=@var{source}
4403 Use @var{source} as the source of the corresponding package.
4404 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
4405 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
4406
4407 The ``corresponding package'' is taken to be the one specified on the
4408 command line the name of which matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
4409 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
4410 package is @code{guile}. Likewise, the version string is inferred from
4411 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
4412
4413 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
4414 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
4415 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
4416 the @code{ed} package:
4417
4418 @example
4419 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
4420 @end example
4421
4422 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
4423 candidates:
4424
4425 @example
4426 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
4427 @end example
4428
4429 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
4430
4431 @example
4432 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
4433 $ guix build guix --with-source=./guix
4434 @end example
4435
4436 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
4437 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
4438 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
4439 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
4440 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
4441
4442 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
4443 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
4444 the development version of Guile, @code{guile-next}:
4445
4446 @example
4447 guix build --with-input=guile=guile-next guix
4448 @end example
4449
4450 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
4451 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
4452 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile-next}.
4453
4454 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
4455 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
4456 @end table
4457
4458 @node Additional Build Options
4459 @subsection Additional Build Options
4460
4461 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
4462 build}.
4463
4464 @table @code
4465
4466 @item --quiet
4467 @itemx -q
4468 Build quietly, without displaying the build log. Upon completion, the
4469 build log is kept in @file{/var} (or similar) and can always be
4470 retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
4471
4472 @item --file=@var{file}
4473 @itemx -f @var{file}
4474
4475 Build the package or derivation that the code within @var{file}
4476 evaluates to.
4477
4478 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
4479 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4480
4481 @example
4482 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
4483 @end example
4484
4485 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4486 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4487 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
4488
4489 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
4490 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
4491 version 1.8 of Guile.
4492
4493 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
4494 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
4495 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
4496
4497 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
4498 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
4499 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
4500
4501 @item --source
4502 @itemx -S
4503 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
4504 themselves.
4505
4506 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
4507 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
4508 source tarball.
4509
4510 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
4511 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
4512 Packages}).
4513
4514 @item --sources
4515 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
4516 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
4517 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
4518 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
4519 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
4520 optional argument values:
4521
4522 @table @code
4523 @item package
4524 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
4525 as the @code{--source} option.
4526
4527 @item all
4528 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
4529 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
4530
4531 @example
4532 $ guix build --sources tzdata
4533 The following derivations will be built:
4534 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
4535 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4536 @end example
4537
4538 @item transitive
4539 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
4540 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g. to
4541 prefetch package source for later offline building.
4542
4543 @example
4544 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
4545 The following derivations will be built:
4546 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4547 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
4548 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
4549 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
4550 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
4551 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
4552 @dots{}
4553 @end example
4554
4555 @end table
4556
4557 @item --system=@var{system}
4558 @itemx -s @var{system}
4559 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4560 the system type of the build host.
4561
4562 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
4563 different personalities. For instance, passing
4564 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system allows users
4565 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
4566
4567 @item --target=@var{triplet}
4568 @cindex cross-compilation
4569 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
4570 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU
4571 configuration triplets,, configure, GNU Configure and Build System}).
4572
4573 @anchor{build-check}
4574 @item --check
4575 @cindex determinism, checking
4576 @cindex reproducibility, checking
4577 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
4578 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
4579 identical.
4580
4581 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
4582 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
4583 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
4584 background information and tools.
4585
4586 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
4587 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
4588 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
4589
4590 @item --derivations
4591 @itemx -d
4592 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
4593 packages.
4594
4595 @item --root=@var{file}
4596 @itemx -r @var{file}
4597 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
4598 collector root.
4599
4600 @item --log-file
4601 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
4602 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
4603 missing.
4604
4605 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
4606 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
4607
4608 @example
4609 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
4610 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
4611 guix build --log-file guile
4612 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
4613 @end example
4614
4615 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
4616 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
4617 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
4618
4619 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
4620 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
4621
4622 @example
4623 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
4624 https://hydra.gnu.org/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
4625 @end example
4626
4627 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
4628 @end table
4629
4630
4631 @node Invoking guix edit
4632 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
4633
4634 @cindex package definition, editing
4635 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
4636 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
4637 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
4638 For instance:
4639
4640 @example
4641 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
4642 @end example
4643
4644 @noindent
4645 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
4646 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
4647 and that of Vim.
4648
4649 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
4650 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
4651 (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will be able to edit the package
4652 recipes. Otherwise, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
4653 for packages currently in the store.
4654
4655 If you are using Emacs, note that the Emacs user interface provides the
4656 @kbd{M-x guix-edit} command and a similar functionality in the ``package
4657 info'' and ``package list'' buffers created by the @kbd{M-x
4658 guix-search-by-name} and similar commands (@pxref{Emacs Commands}).
4659
4660
4661 @node Invoking guix download
4662 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
4663
4664 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
4665 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
4666 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
4667 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
4668 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
4669 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
4670
4671 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
4672 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
4673 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
4674 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
4675 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
4676 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4677
4678 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
4679 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
4680 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
4681 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
4682 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
4683 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
4684 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
4685
4686 The following option is available:
4687
4688 @table @code
4689 @item --format=@var{fmt}
4690 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
4691 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
4692 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
4693 @end table
4694
4695 @node Invoking guix hash
4696 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
4697
4698 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
4699 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
4700 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
4701 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4702
4703 The general syntax is:
4704
4705 @example
4706 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
4707 @end example
4708
4709 @command{guix hash} has the following options:
4710
4711 @table @code
4712
4713 @item --format=@var{fmt}
4714 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
4715 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
4716
4717 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
4718 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
4719
4720 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
4721 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
4722 in the definitions of packages.
4723
4724 @item --recursive
4725 @itemx -r
4726 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
4727
4728 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
4729 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
4730 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
4731 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
4732 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
4733 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
4734 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
4735 @c it exists.
4736
4737 @item --exclude-vcs
4738 @itemx -x
4739 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
4740 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.)
4741
4742 @vindex git-fetch
4743 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
4744 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
4745 Reference}):
4746
4747 @example
4748 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
4749 $ cd foo
4750 $ guix hash -rx .
4751 @end example
4752 @end table
4753
4754 @node Invoking guix import
4755 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
4756
4757 @cindex importing packages
4758 @cindex package import
4759 @cindex package conversion
4760 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
4761 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
4762 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
4763 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
4764 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
4765 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4766
4767 The general syntax is:
4768
4769 @example
4770 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
4771 @end example
4772
4773 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
4774 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
4775 options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
4776 ``importers'' are:
4777
4778 @table @code
4779 @item gnu
4780 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
4781 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
4782 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
4783
4784 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
4785 license needs to be figured out manually.
4786
4787 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
4788 GNU@tie{}Hello:
4789
4790 @example
4791 guix import gnu hello
4792 @end example
4793
4794 Specific command-line options are:
4795
4796 @table @code
4797 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
4798 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
4799 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
4800 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
4801 @end table
4802
4803 @item pypi
4804 @cindex pypi
4805 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
4806 Index}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
4807 @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted
4808 description available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all
4809 the relevant information, including package dependencies. For maximum
4810 efficiency, it is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so
4811 that the importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
4812
4813 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
4814 package:
4815
4816 @example
4817 guix import pypi itsdangerous
4818 @end example
4819
4820 @item gem
4821 @cindex gem
4822 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/,
4823 RubyGems}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be
4824 installed. @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the
4825 JSON-formatted description available at @code{rubygems.org} and includes
4826 most relevant information, including runtime dependencies. There are
4827 some caveats, however. The metadata doesn't distinguish between
4828 synopses and descriptions, so the same string is used for both fields.
4829 Additionally, the details of non-Ruby dependencies required to build
4830 native extensions is unavailable and left as an exercise to the
4831 packager.
4832
4833 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
4834
4835 @example
4836 guix import gem rails
4837 @end example
4838
4839 @item cpan
4840 @cindex CPAN
4841 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}@footnote{This
4842 functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
4843 @xref{Requirements}.}.
4844 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
4845 @uref{https://api.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
4846 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
4847 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
4848 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
4849 list of dependencies.
4850
4851 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
4852 Perl module:
4853
4854 @example
4855 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
4856 @end example
4857
4858 @item cran
4859 @cindex CRAN
4860 @cindex Bioconductor
4861 Import metadata from @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
4862 central repository for the @uref{http://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
4863 statistical and graphical environment}.
4864
4865 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
4866
4867 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
4868 R package:
4869
4870 @example
4871 guix import cran Cairo
4872 @end example
4873
4874 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
4875 @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
4876 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
4877 genomic data in bioinformatics.
4878
4879 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of a package
4880 published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
4881
4882 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
4883 R package:
4884
4885 @example
4886 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
4887 @end example
4888
4889 @item nix
4890 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
4891 @uref{http://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
4892 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
4893 @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
4894 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
4895 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
4896 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
4897 package definition.
4898
4899 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
4900 by their canonical upstream variant.
4901
4902 Usually, you will first need to do:
4903
4904 @example
4905 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
4906 @end example
4907
4908 @noindent
4909 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
4910
4911 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
4912 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
4913 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
4914
4915 @example
4916 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
4917 @end example
4918
4919 @item hackage
4920 @cindex hackage
4921 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
4922 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
4923 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
4924 dependencies.
4925
4926 Specific command-line options are:
4927
4928 @table @code
4929 @item --stdin
4930 @itemx -s
4931 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
4932 @item --no-test-dependencies
4933 @itemx -t
4934 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
4935 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
4936 @itemx -e @var{alist}
4937 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
4938 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
4939 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
4940 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
4941 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
4942 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
4943 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
4944 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
4945 @end table
4946
4947 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
4948 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
4949 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
4950
4951 @example
4952 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
4953 @end example
4954
4955 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
4956 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
4957
4958 @example
4959 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
4960 @end example
4961
4962 @item elpa
4963 @cindex elpa
4964 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
4965 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
4966
4967 Specific command-line options are:
4968
4969 @table @code
4970 @item --archive=@var{repo}
4971 @itemx -a @var{repo}
4972 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
4973 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
4974 are:
4975 @itemize -
4976 @item
4977 @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
4978 identifier. This is the default.
4979
4980 @item
4981 @uref{http://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
4982 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
4983
4984 @item
4985 @uref{http://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
4986 identifier.
4987 @end itemize
4988 @end table
4989 @end table
4990
4991 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
4992 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
4993 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
4994
4995 @node Invoking guix refresh
4996 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
4997
4998 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
4999 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
5000 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
5001 upstream version, like this:
5002
5003 @example
5004 $ guix refresh
5005 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
5006 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
5007 @end example
5008
5009 It does so by browsing the FTP directory of each package and determining
5010 the highest version number of the source tarballs therein. The command
5011 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
5012 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. The
5013 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
5014 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
5015 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
5016
5017 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
5018 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
5019 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
5020 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
5021 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
5022 using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
5023 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
5024 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
5025 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
5026 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
5027
5028 The following options are supported:
5029
5030 @table @code
5031
5032 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5033 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5034 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
5035
5036 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
5037
5038 @example
5039 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
5040 @end example
5041
5042 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
5043 the packages.)
5044
5045 @item --update
5046 @itemx -u
5047 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
5048 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
5049 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
5050
5051 @example
5052 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core
5053 @end example
5054
5055 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
5056
5057 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
5058 @itemx -s @var{subset}
5059 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
5060 @code{non-core}.
5061
5062 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
5063 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
5064 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
5065 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
5066 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
5067 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
5068
5069 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
5070 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
5071 inconvenient.
5072
5073 @item --type=@var{updater}
5074 @itemx -t @var{updater}
5075 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
5076 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
5077
5078 @table @code
5079 @item gnu
5080 the updater for GNU packages;
5081 @item gnome
5082 the updater for GNOME packages;
5083 @item kde
5084 the updater for KDE packages;
5085 @item xorg
5086 the updater for X.org packages;
5087 @item elpa
5088 the updater for @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
5089 @item cran
5090 the updater for @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
5091 @item bioconductor
5092 the updater for @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
5093 @item pypi
5094 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
5095 @item gem
5096 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
5097 @item github
5098 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
5099 @item hackage
5100 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
5101 @end table
5102
5103 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
5104 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
5105
5106 @example
5107 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
5108 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
5109 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
5110 @end example
5111
5112 @end table
5113
5114 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
5115 names, as in this example:
5116
5117 @example
5118 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc-4.8.4
5119 @end example
5120
5121 @noindent
5122 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
5123 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
5124 effect in this case.
5125
5126 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
5127 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
5128 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
5129 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
5130
5131 @table @code
5132
5133 @item --list-updaters
5134 @itemx -L
5135 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
5136
5137 @item --list-dependent
5138 @itemx -l
5139 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
5140 result of upgrading one or more packages.
5141
5142 @end table
5143
5144 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
5145 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
5146 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
5147
5148 @example
5149 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
5150 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
5151 hop-2.4.0 geiser-0.4 notmuch-0.18 mu-0.9.9.5 cflow-1.4 idutils-4.6 @dots{}
5152 @end example
5153
5154 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
5155 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
5156
5157 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
5158
5159 @table @code
5160
5161 @item --gpg=@var{command}
5162 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
5163 for in @code{$PATH}.
5164
5165 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
5166 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
5167 of:
5168
5169 @table @code
5170 @item always
5171 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
5172 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
5173
5174 @item never
5175 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
5176
5177 @item interactive
5178 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
5179 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
5180 @end table
5181
5182 @item --key-server=@var{host}
5183 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
5184
5185 @end table
5186
5187 The @code{github} updater uses the
5188 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
5189 releases. When used repeatedly e.g. when refreshing all packages,
5190 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
5191 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
5192 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
5193 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
5194 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
5195 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
5196 otherwise.
5197
5198
5199 @node Invoking guix lint
5200 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
5201 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
5202 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
5203 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
5204 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
5205 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
5206
5207 @table @code
5208 @item synopsis
5209 @itemx description
5210 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
5211 descriptions and synopses.
5212
5213 @item inputs-should-be-native
5214 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
5215
5216 @item source
5217 @itemx home-page
5218 @itemx source-file-name
5219 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
5220 invalid. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g. is not
5221 just a version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared
5222 @code{file-name} (@pxref{origin Reference}).
5223
5224 @item cve
5225 @cindex security vulnerabilities
5226 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
5227 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
5228 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
5229 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
5230 NIST}.
5231
5232 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
5233
5234 @itemize
5235 @item
5236 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
5237 @item
5238 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
5239 @end itemize
5240
5241 @noindent
5242 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
5243 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
5244
5245 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
5246 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/cpe.cfm,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
5247 name and version of the package when they differ from the name that Guix
5248 uses, as in this example:
5249
5250 @example
5251 (package
5252 (name "grub")
5253 ;; @dots{}
5254 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
5255 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2"))))
5256 @end example
5257
5258 @item formatting
5259 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
5260 use of tabulations, etc.
5261 @end table
5262
5263 The general syntax is:
5264
5265 @example
5266 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5267 @end example
5268
5269 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
5270 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
5271
5272 @table @code
5273 @item --list-checkers
5274 @itemx -l
5275 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
5276 and exit.
5277
5278 @item --checkers
5279 @itemx -c
5280 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
5281 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
5282
5283 @end table
5284
5285 @node Invoking guix size
5286 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
5287
5288 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
5289 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
5290 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
5291 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
5292 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
5293 @command{guix size} can highlight.
5294
5295 The command can be passed a package specification such as @code{gcc-4.8}
5296 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
5297 example:
5298
5299 @example
5300 $ guix size coreutils
5301 store item total self
5302 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23 70.0 13.9 19.8%
5303 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.0.0a 55.3 2.5 3.6%
5304 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 53.7 0.5 0.7%
5305 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.46 53.2 0.3 0.5%
5306 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.4-lib 52.9 15.7 22.4%
5307 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.21 37.2 37.2 53.1%
5308 @end example
5309
5310 @cindex closure
5311 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
5312 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
5313 would be returned by:
5314
5315 @example
5316 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
5317 @end example
5318
5319 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
5320 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
5321 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
5322 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
5323 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
5324 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
5325
5326 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
5327 70@tie{}MiB, half of which is taken by libc. (That libc represents a
5328 large fraction of the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because it is
5329 always available on the system anyway.)
5330
5331 When the package passed to @command{guix size} is available in the
5332 store, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
5333 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
5334 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
5335 Coreutils}).
5336
5337 When the given package is @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
5338 reports information based on the available substitutes
5339 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
5340 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
5341
5342 You can also specify several package names:
5343
5344 @example
5345 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
5346 store item total self
5347 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
5348 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
5349 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
5350 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
5351 @dots{}
5352 total: 102.3 MiB
5353 @end example
5354
5355 @noindent
5356 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
5357 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
5358 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
5359
5360 The available options are:
5361
5362 @table @option
5363
5364 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
5365 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
5366 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
5367
5368 @item --map-file=@var{file}
5369 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
5370
5371 For the example above, the map looks like this:
5372
5373 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
5374 produced by @command{guix size}}
5375
5376 This option requires that
5377 @uref{http://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
5378 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
5379 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
5380
5381 @item --system=@var{system}
5382 @itemx -s @var{system}
5383 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
5384
5385 @end table
5386
5387 @node Invoking guix graph
5388 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
5389
5390 @cindex DAG
5391 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
5392 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
5393 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
5394 provides a visual representation of the DAG. @command{guix graph}
5395 emits a DAG representation in the input format of
5396 @uref{http://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
5397 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. The general
5398 syntax is:
5399
5400 @example
5401 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5402 @end example
5403
5404 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
5405 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
5406 dependencies:
5407
5408 @example
5409 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
5410 @end example
5411
5412 The output looks like this:
5413
5414 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
5415
5416 Nice little graph, no?
5417
5418 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
5419 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
5420 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
5421 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
5422 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
5423
5424 @table @code
5425 @item package
5426 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
5427 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
5428 filters out many details.
5429
5430 @item bag-emerged
5431 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
5432
5433 For instance, the following command:
5434
5435 @example
5436 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
5437 @end example
5438
5439 ... yields this bigger graph:
5440
5441 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
5442
5443 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
5444 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
5445
5446 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
5447 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
5448 here, for conciseness.
5449
5450 @item bag
5451 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
5452 dependencies.
5453
5454 @item bag-with-origins
5455 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
5456
5457 @item derivations
5458 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
5459 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
5460 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
5461 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
5462
5463 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
5464 name instead of a package name, as in:
5465
5466 @example
5467 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
5468 @end example
5469 @end table
5470
5471 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
5472 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
5473
5474 @table @code
5475 @item references
5476 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
5477 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
5478
5479 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
5480 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
5481
5482 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
5483 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
5484 (which can be big!):
5485
5486 @example
5487 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
5488 @end example
5489 @end table
5490
5491 The available options are the following:
5492
5493 @table @option
5494 @item --type=@var{type}
5495 @itemx -t @var{type}
5496 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
5497 the values listed above.
5498
5499 @item --list-types
5500 List the supported graph types.
5501
5502 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5503 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5504 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
5505
5506 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
5507
5508 @example
5509 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
5510 @end example
5511 @end table
5512
5513
5514 @node Invoking guix environment
5515 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
5516
5517 @cindex reproducible build environments
5518 @cindex development environments
5519 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
5520 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
5521 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
5522 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
5523 environment to use them.
5524
5525 The general syntax is:
5526
5527 @example
5528 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5529 @end example
5530
5531 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
5532 GNU@tie{}Guile:
5533
5534 @example
5535 guix environment guile
5536 @end example
5537
5538 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
5539 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
5540 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
5541 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
5542 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
5543 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
5544 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
5545 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
5546 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
5547 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
5548 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
5549 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
5550 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
5551 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
5552 details on Bash start-up files.}.
5553
5554 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5555 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5556 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
5557 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
5558 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5559 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5560
5561 @example
5562 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5563 then
5564 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5565 fi
5566 @end example
5567
5568 @noindent
5569 ... or to browse the profile:
5570
5571 @example
5572 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
5573 @end example
5574
5575 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5576 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5577 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5578 and Emacs are available:
5579
5580 @example
5581 guix environment guile emacs
5582 @end example
5583
5584 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5585 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5586 command from the rest of the arguments:
5587
5588 @example
5589 guix environment guile -- make -j4
5590 @end example
5591
5592 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5593 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5594 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5595 NumPy:
5596
5597 @example
5598 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
5599 @end example
5600
5601 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5602 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5603 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5604 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5605 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5606 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5607 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5608 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5609 additionally includes Git and strace:
5610
5611 @example
5612 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
5613 @end example
5614
5615 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5616 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5617 using Guix on a host distro that is not GuixSD, it is desirable to
5618 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5619 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5620 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5621 working directory are mounted:
5622
5623 @example
5624 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5625 @end example
5626
5627 @quotation Note
5628 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
5629 @end quotation
5630
5631 The available options are summarized below.
5632
5633 @table @code
5634 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5635 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5636 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5637 @var{expr} evaluates to.
5638
5639 For example, running:
5640
5641 @example
5642 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5643 @end example
5644
5645 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5646 PETSc package.
5647
5648 Running:
5649
5650 @example
5651 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
5652 @end example
5653
5654 starts a shell with all the GuixSD base packages available.
5655
5656 The above commands only the use default output of the given packages.
5657 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
5658
5659 @example
5660 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
5661 @end example
5662
5663 @item --load=@var{file}
5664 @itemx -l @var{file}
5665 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5666 within @var{file} evaluates to.
5667
5668 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5669 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5670
5671 @example
5672 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5673 @end example
5674
5675 @item --ad-hoc
5676 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5677 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5678 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5679 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5680
5681 For instance, the command:
5682
5683 @example
5684 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
5685 @end example
5686
5687 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5688 available.
5689
5690 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5691 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
5692 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5693 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5694
5695 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5696 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
5697 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
5698 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
5699 that will be added to the environment directly.
5700
5701 @item --pure
5702 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment.
5703 This has the effect of creating an environment in which search paths
5704 only contain package inputs.
5705
5706 @item --search-paths
5707 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5708 environment.
5709
5710 @item --system=@var{system}
5711 @itemx -s @var{system}
5712 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
5713
5714 @item --container
5715 @itemx -C
5716 @cindex container
5717 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
5718 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
5719 Additionally, a dummy home directory is created that matches the current
5720 user's home directory, and @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
5721 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container, but
5722 has root privileges in the context of the container.
5723
5724 @item --network
5725 @itemx -N
5726 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5727 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5728 device.
5729
5730 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5731 For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
5732 as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
5733 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5734 point in the container.
5735
5736 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5737 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5738 directory:
5739
5740 @example
5741 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5742 @end example
5743
5744 @item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5745 For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
5746 as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
5747 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5748 point in the container.
5749
5750 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5751 home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
5752 @file{/exchange} directory:
5753
5754 @example
5755 guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5756 @end example
5757 @end table
5758
5759 It also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
5760 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
5761
5762 @node Invoking guix publish
5763 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
5764
5765 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
5766 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
5767 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
5768
5769 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
5770 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
5771 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
5772 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Hydra, the software behind
5773 the @code{hydra.gnu.org} build farm.
5774
5775 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
5776 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
5777 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
5778 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
5779 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
5780
5781 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
5782 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
5783 guix archive}).
5784
5785 The general syntax is:
5786
5787 @example
5788 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
5789 @end example
5790
5791 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
5792 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
5793
5794 @example
5795 guix publish
5796 @end example
5797
5798 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
5799 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
5800
5801 @example
5802 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
5803 @end example
5804
5805 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
5806 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
5807 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
5808 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
5809 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
5810 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
5811
5812 @example
5813 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
5814 @end example
5815
5816 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
5817 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
5818
5819 The following options are available:
5820
5821 @table @code
5822 @item --port=@var{port}
5823 @itemx -p @var{port}
5824 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
5825
5826 @item --listen=@var{host}
5827 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
5828 accept connections from any interface.
5829
5830 @item --user=@var{user}
5831 @itemx -u @var{user}
5832 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
5833 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
5834
5835 @item --compression[=@var{level}]
5836 @itemx -C [@var{level}]
5837 Compress data using the given @var{level}. When @var{level} is zero,
5838 disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds to different gzip
5839 compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best (CPU-intensive).
5840 The default is 3.
5841
5842 Compression occurs on the fly and the compressed streams are not
5843 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
5844 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, or to
5845 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy.
5846
5847 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
5848 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
5849 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
5850 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
5851
5852 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
5853 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
5854 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
5855 for as long as @var{ttl}.
5856
5857 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
5858 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
5859 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
5860 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
5861 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
5862 @end table
5863
5864 Enabling @command{guix publish} on a GuixSD system is a one-liner: just
5865 add a call to @code{guix-publish-service} in the @code{services} field
5866 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service,
5867 @code{guix-publish-service}}).
5868
5869
5870 @node Invoking guix challenge
5871 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
5872
5873 @cindex reproducible builds
5874 @cindex verifiable builds
5875
5876 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
5877 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
5878 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
5879 answer.
5880
5881 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
5882 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
5883 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
5884 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
5885 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
5886 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
5887 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
5888
5889 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
5890 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
5891 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
5892 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
5893 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
5894 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
5895 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
5896 any given store item.
5897
5898 The command output looks like this:
5899
5900 @smallexample
5901 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://hydra.gnu.org https://guix.example.org"
5902 updating list of substitutes from 'https://hydra.gnu.org'... 100.0%
5903 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
5904 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
5905 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5906 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5907 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
5908 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
5909 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
5910 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
5911 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
5912 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
5913 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5914 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5915 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
5916 @end smallexample
5917
5918 @noindent
5919 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
5920 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
5921 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
5922 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
5923 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
5924
5925 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
5926 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
5927 Conversely, @code{hydra.gnu.org} agrees with local builds, except in the
5928 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
5929 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
5930 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
5931 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
5932 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
5933 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
5934 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
5935 more information.
5936
5937 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
5938 these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
5939
5940 @example
5941 $ wget -q -O - https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
5942 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
5943 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
5944 @end example
5945
5946 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
5947 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
5948 @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
5949 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
5950 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
5951 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
5952 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
5953
5954 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
5955 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
5956 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
5957 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
5958 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
5959 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
5960 the problem.
5961
5962 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
5963 whether @code{hydra.gnu.org} and other substitute servers obtain the
5964 same build result as you did with:
5965
5966 @example
5967 $ guix challenge @var{package}
5968 @end example
5969
5970 @noindent
5971 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
5972 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
5973
5974 The general syntax is:
5975
5976 @example
5977 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
5978 @end example
5979
5980 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
5981 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
5982 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
5983 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
5984 errors.)
5985
5986 The one option that matters is:
5987
5988 @table @code
5989
5990 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
5991 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
5992 URLs to compare to.
5993
5994 @end table
5995
5996
5997 @node Invoking guix container
5998 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
5999 @cindex container
6000
6001 @quotation Note
6002 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
6003 is subject to radical change in the future.
6004 @end quotation
6005
6006 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
6007 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
6008 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
6009 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
6010 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
6011
6012 The general syntax is:
6013
6014 @example
6015 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
6016 @end example
6017
6018 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
6019 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
6020
6021 The following actions are available:
6022
6023 @table @code
6024 @item exec
6025 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
6026
6027 The syntax is:
6028
6029 @example
6030 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
6031 @end example
6032
6033 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
6034 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
6035 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
6036 will be passed to @var{program}.
6037
6038 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
6039 GuixSD container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
6040 process ID is 9001:
6041
6042 @example
6043 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
6044 @end example
6045
6046 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
6047 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
6048
6049 @end table
6050
6051 @c *********************************************************************
6052 @node GNU Distribution
6053 @chapter GNU Distribution
6054
6055 @cindex Guix System Distribution
6056 @cindex GuixSD
6057 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
6058 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
6059 @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
6060 users of that software}.}. The
6061 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
6062 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
6063 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). To distinguish
6064 between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as the Guix
6065 System Distribution, or GuixSD.
6066
6067 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
6068 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
6069 list of available packages can be browsed
6070 @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
6071 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
6072
6073 @example
6074 guix package --list-available
6075 @end example
6076
6077 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
6078 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
6079 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
6080 tools that help users exert that freedom.
6081
6082 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
6083
6084 @table @code
6085
6086 @item x86_64-linux
6087 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
6088
6089 @item i686-linux
6090 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
6091
6092 @item armhf-linux
6093 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
6094 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
6095 and Linux-Libre kernel.
6096
6097 @item mips64el-linux
6098 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
6099 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel.
6100
6101 @end table
6102
6103 GuixSD itself is currently only available on @code{i686} and @code{x86_64}.
6104
6105 @noindent
6106 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
6107 @pxref{Porting}.
6108
6109 @menu
6110 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
6111 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
6112 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
6113 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
6114 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
6115 * Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
6116 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
6117 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
6118 @end menu
6119
6120 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
6121 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
6122
6123 @node System Installation
6124 @section System Installation
6125
6126 @cindex Guix System Distribution
6127 This section explains how to install the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD)
6128 on a machine. The Guix package manager can
6129 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
6130 @pxref{Installation}.
6131
6132 @ifinfo
6133 @quotation Note
6134 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
6135 @c installation image.
6136 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
6137 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
6138 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
6139 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
6140
6141 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
6142 available.
6143 @end quotation
6144 @end ifinfo
6145
6146 @menu
6147 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
6148 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
6149 * USB Stick Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
6150 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
6151 * Proceeding with the Installation:: The real thing.
6152 * Installing GuixSD in a VM:: GuixSD playground.
6153 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
6154 @end menu
6155
6156 @node Limitations
6157 @subsection Limitations
6158
6159 As of version @value{VERSION}, the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD) is
6160 not production-ready. It may contain bugs and lack important
6161 features. Thus, if you are looking for a stable production system that
6162 respects your freedom as a computer user, a good solution at this point
6163 is to consider @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-distros.html, one of
6164 the more established GNU/Linux distributions}. We hope you can soon switch
6165 to the GuixSD without fear, of course. In the meantime, you can
6166 also keep using your distribution and try out the package manager on top
6167 of it (@pxref{Installation}).
6168
6169 Before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the following
6170 noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
6171
6172 @itemize
6173 @item
6174 The installation process does not include a graphical user interface and
6175 requires familiarity with GNU/Linux (see the following subsections to
6176 get a feel of what that means.)
6177
6178 @item
6179 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
6180
6181 @item
6182 Few system services are currently supported out-of-the-box
6183 (@pxref{Services}).
6184
6185 @item
6186 More than 4,000 packages are available, but you may
6187 occasionally find that a useful package is missing.
6188
6189 @item
6190 GNOME, Xfce, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
6191 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, some graphical
6192 applications may be missing, as well as KDE.
6193 @end itemize
6194
6195 You have been warned! But more than a disclaimer, this is an invitation
6196 to report issues (and success stories!), and to join us in improving it.
6197 @xref{Contributing}, for more info.
6198
6199
6200 @node Hardware Considerations
6201 @subsection Hardware Considerations
6202
6203 @cindex hardware support on GuixSD
6204 GNU@tie{}GuixSD focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
6205 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
6206 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
6207 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
6208 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
6209 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
6210 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
6211 hardware is not supported on GuixSD.
6212
6213 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
6214 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
6215 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
6216 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
6217 driver, and for which free firmware exists and is available
6218 out-of-the-box on GuixSD, as part of @var{%base-firmware}
6219 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
6220
6221 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
6222 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
6223 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
6224 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
6225 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
6226 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
6227
6228 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
6229 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
6230 about their support in GNU/Linux.
6231
6232
6233 @node USB Stick Installation
6234 @subsection USB Stick Installation
6235
6236 An installation image for USB sticks can be downloaded from
6237 @indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz},
6238 where @var{system} is one of:
6239
6240 @table @code
6241 @item x86_64-linux
6242 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
6243
6244 @item i686-linux
6245 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
6246 @end table
6247
6248 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
6249 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
6250 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
6251
6252 @example
6253 $ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz.sig
6254 $ gpg --verify guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz.sig
6255 @end example
6256
6257 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
6258 then run this command to import it:
6259
6260 @example
6261 $ gpg --keyserver pgp.mit.edu --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
6262 @end example
6263
6264 @noindent
6265 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
6266 @c end duplication
6267
6268 This image contains a single partition with the tools necessary for an
6269 installation. It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough
6270 USB stick.
6271
6272 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
6273
6274 @enumerate
6275 @item
6276 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
6277
6278 @example
6279 xz -d guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz
6280 @end example
6281
6282 @item
6283 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
6284 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
6285 copy the image with:
6286
6287 @example
6288 dd if=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64 of=/dev/sdX
6289 @end example
6290
6291 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
6292 @end enumerate
6293
6294 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
6295 the USB stick. The latter usually requires you to get in the BIOS' boot
6296 menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
6297
6298 @xref{Installing GuixSD in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
6299 GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM).
6300
6301 @node Preparing for Installation
6302 @subsection Preparing for Installation
6303
6304 Once you have successfully booted the image on the USB stick, you should
6305 end up with a root prompt. Several console TTYs are configured and can
6306 be used to run commands as root. TTY2 shows this documentation,
6307 browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
6308 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse
6309 daemon, which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and
6310 to paste it with the middle button.
6311
6312 @quotation Note
6313 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
6314 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
6315 ``Networking'' section below.
6316 @end quotation
6317
6318 The installation system includes many common tools needed for this task.
6319 But it is also a full-blown GuixSD system, which means that you can
6320 install additional packages, should you need it, using @command{guix
6321 package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
6322
6323 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
6324
6325 @cindex keyboard layout
6326 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
6327 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
6328 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
6329
6330 @example
6331 loadkeys dvorak
6332 @end example
6333
6334 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
6335 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
6336 more information.
6337
6338 @subsubsection Networking
6339
6340 Run the following command see what your network interfaces are called:
6341
6342 @example
6343 ifconfig -a
6344 @end example
6345
6346 @noindent
6347 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
6348
6349 @example
6350 ip a
6351 @end example
6352
6353 @c http://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
6354 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
6355 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
6356 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
6357 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
6358
6359 @table @asis
6360 @item Wired connection
6361 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
6362 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
6363
6364 @example
6365 ifconfig @var{interface} up
6366 @end example
6367
6368 @item Wireless connection
6369 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
6370 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
6371 important) using one of the available text editors such as
6372 @command{zile}:
6373
6374 @example
6375 zile wpa_supplicant.conf
6376 @end example
6377
6378 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
6379 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
6380 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
6381
6382 @example
6383 network=@{
6384 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
6385 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
6386 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
6387 @}
6388 @end example
6389
6390 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
6391 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
6392 network interface you want to use):
6393
6394 @example
6395 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
6396 @end example
6397
6398 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
6399 @end table
6400
6401 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
6402 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
6403
6404 @example
6405 dhclient -v @var{interface}
6406 @end example
6407
6408 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
6409
6410 @example
6411 ping -c 3 gnu.org
6412 @end example
6413
6414 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
6415 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
6416
6417 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
6418
6419 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
6420 then format the target partition(s).
6421
6422 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
6423 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
6424 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
6425 the partition layout you want:
6426
6427 @example
6428 cfdisk
6429 @end example
6430
6431 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
6432 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
6433 GuixSD pretty much assumes an ext4 file system. In particular, code
6434 that reads partition UUIDs and labels only works with ext4. This will
6435 be fixed in the future.}.
6436
6437 Preferably, assign partitions a label so that you can easily and
6438 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
6439 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
6440 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
6441 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda1}, a file system with the label
6442 @code{my-root} can be created with:
6443
6444 @example
6445 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda1
6446 @end example
6447
6448 @c FIXME: Uncomment this once GRUB fully supports encrypted roots.
6449 @c A typical command sequence may be:
6450 @c
6451 @c @example
6452 @c # fdisk /dev/sdX
6453 @c @dots{} Create partitions etc.@dots{}
6454 @c # cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sdX1
6455 @c # cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sdX1 my-partition
6456 @c # mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
6457 @c @end example
6458
6459 In addition to e2fsprogs, the suite of tools to manipulate
6460 ext2/ext3/ext4 file systems, the installation image includes
6461 Cryptsetup/LUKS for disk encryption.
6462
6463 Once that is done, mount the target root partition under @file{/mnt}
6464 with a command like (again, assuming @file{/dev/sda1} is the root
6465 partition):
6466
6467 @example
6468 mount /dev/sda1 /mnt
6469 @end example
6470
6471 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
6472 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
6473 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
6474 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, you would run:
6475
6476 @example
6477 mkswap /dev/sda2
6478 @end example
6479
6480 @node Proceeding with the Installation
6481 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
6482
6483 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
6484 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
6485
6486 @example
6487 herd start cow-store /mnt
6488 @end example
6489
6490 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
6491 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
6492 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
6493 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
6494 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
6495
6496 Next, you have to edit a file and
6497 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
6498 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors: GNU nano
6499 (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
6500 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
6501 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
6502 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
6503 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
6504
6505 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
6506 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
6507 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
6508 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
6509 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
6510 something along these lines:
6511
6512 @example
6513 # mkdir /mnt/etc
6514 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
6515 # zile /mnt/etc/config.scm
6516 @end example
6517
6518 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
6519 in particular:
6520
6521 @itemize
6522 @item
6523 Make sure the @code{grub-configuration} form refers to the device you
6524 want to install GRUB on.
6525
6526 @item
6527 Be sure that your partition labels match the value of their respective
6528 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
6529 your @code{file-system} configuration sets the value of @code{title} to
6530 @code{'label}.
6531 @end itemize
6532
6533 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
6534 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
6535 under @file{/mnt}):
6536
6537 @example
6538 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
6539 @end example
6540
6541 @noindent
6542 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
6543 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-grub} option. For
6544 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
6545 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
6546
6547 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
6548 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
6549 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
6550 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
6551 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
6552 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
6553
6554 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
6555 @file{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience---good or not so
6556 good.
6557
6558 @node Installing GuixSD in a VM
6559 @subsection Installing GuixSD in a Virtual Machine
6560
6561 @cindex virtual machine, GuixSD installation
6562 If you'd like to install GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) rather than on
6563 your beloved machine, this section is for you.
6564
6565 To boot a @uref{http://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing GuixSD in a
6566 disk image, follow these steps:
6567
6568 @enumerate
6569 @item
6570 First, retrieve the GuixSD installation image as described previously
6571 (@pxref{USB Stick Installation}).
6572
6573 @item
6574 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
6575 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
6576
6577 @example
6578 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guixsd.img 5G
6579 @end example
6580
6581 This will create a 5GB file.
6582
6583 @item
6584 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
6585
6586 @example
6587 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 \
6588 -net default -net nic,model=virtio -boot menu=on \
6589 -drive file=guixsd.img \
6590 -drive file=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}
6591 @end example
6592
6593 In the VM console, quickly press the @kbd{F12} key to enter the boot
6594 menu. Then press the @kbd{2} key and the @kbd{RET} key to validate your
6595 selection.
6596
6597 @item
6598 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
6599 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
6600 @end enumerate
6601
6602 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
6603 @file{guixsd.img} image. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM}, for how to do
6604 that.
6605
6606 @node Building the Installation Image
6607 @subsection Building the Installation Image
6608
6609 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
6610 system} command, specifically:
6611
6612 @c FIXME: 1G is too much; see <http://bugs.gnu.org/23077>.
6613 @example
6614 guix system disk-image --image-size=1G gnu/system/install.scm
6615 @end example
6616
6617 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
6618 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
6619 about the installation image.
6620
6621 @node System Configuration
6622 @section System Configuration
6623
6624 @cindex system configuration
6625 The Guix System Distribution supports a consistent whole-system configuration
6626 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
6627 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
6628 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
6629 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
6630
6631 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
6632 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
6633 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
6634 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
6635 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
6636 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
6637 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
6638 the own tools of the system.
6639 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
6640
6641 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
6642 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
6643 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
6644 instance to support new system services.
6645
6646 @menu
6647 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
6648 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
6649 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
6650 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
6651 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
6652 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
6653 * Services:: Specifying system services.
6654 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
6655 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
6656 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
6657 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
6658 * GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
6659 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
6660 * Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
6661 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
6662 @end menu
6663
6664 @node Using the Configuration System
6665 @subsection Using the Configuration System
6666
6667 The operating system is configured by providing an
6668 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
6669 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
6670 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
6671 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
6672
6673 @findex operating-system
6674 @lisp
6675 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
6676 @end lisp
6677
6678 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
6679 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
6680 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
6681 which case they get a default value.
6682
6683 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
6684 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
6685 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
6686 @command{guix system}.
6687
6688 @unnumberedsubsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
6689
6690 @vindex %base-packages
6691 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
6692 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
6693 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
6694 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @var{%base-packages} variable
6695 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
6696 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
6697 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
6698 etc. The example above adds tcpdump to those, taken from the @code{(gnu
6699 packages admin)} module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
6700
6701 @findex specification->package
6702 Referring to packages by variable name, like @var{tcpdump} above, has
6703 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
6704 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
6705 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
6706 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
6707 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
6708 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
6709 version:
6710
6711 @lisp
6712 (use-modules (gnu packages))
6713
6714 (operating-system
6715 ;; ...
6716 (packages (append (map specification->package
6717 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
6718 %base-packages)))
6719 @end lisp
6720
6721 @unnumberedsubsubsec System Services
6722
6723 @vindex %base-services
6724 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
6725 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
6726 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
6727 addition to the basic services, we want the @command{lshd} secure shell
6728 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
6729 @code{lsh-service}}). Under the hood,
6730 @code{lsh-service} arranges so that @code{lshd} is started with the
6731 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
6732 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
6733
6734 @cindex customization, of services
6735 @findex modify-services
6736 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
6737 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
6738 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
6739
6740 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
6741 (the console log-in) in the @var{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
6742 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
6743 following in your operating system declaration:
6744
6745 @lisp
6746 (define %my-services
6747 ;; My very own list of services.
6748 (modify-services %base-services
6749 (guix-service-type config =>
6750 (guix-configuration
6751 (inherit config)
6752 (use-substitutes? #f)
6753 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
6754 (mingetty-service-type config =>
6755 (mingetty-configuration
6756 (inherit config)))))
6757
6758 (operating-system
6759 ;; @dots{}
6760 (services %my-services))
6761 @end lisp
6762
6763 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
6764 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
6765 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @var{%base-services} list.
6766 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
6767 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
6768 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
6769 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
6770 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
6771 configuration, but with a few modifications.
6772
6773 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with the X11 display
6774 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
6775 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
6776 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
6777
6778 @lisp
6779 @include os-config-desktop.texi
6780 @end lisp
6781
6782 A graphical environment with a choice of lightweight window managers
6783 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
6784
6785 @lisp
6786 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
6787 @end lisp
6788
6789 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
6790 @var{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
6791 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
6792
6793 Again, @var{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
6794 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
6795 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
6796 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
6797 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
6798 @var{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
6799
6800 @example
6801 (remove (lambda (service)
6802 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
6803 %desktop-services)
6804 @end example
6805
6806 @unnumberedsubsubsec Instantiating the System
6807
6808 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
6809 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
6810 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
6811 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
6812 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
6813
6814 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
6815 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
6816 have to touch files in @command{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
6817 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
6818 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
6819 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
6820 system, should you ever need to.
6821
6822 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
6823 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
6824 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
6825 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
6826 an entry in the GRUB boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
6827 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
6828 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
6829 generations available on disk.
6830
6831 @unnumberedsubsubsec The Programming Interface
6832
6833 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
6834 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
6835 Monad}):
6836
6837 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
6838 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
6839 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
6840
6841 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
6842 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
6843 instantiate @var{os}.
6844 @end deffn
6845
6846 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
6847 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
6848 guts of GuixSD. Make sure to visit it!
6849
6850
6851 @node operating-system Reference
6852 @subsection @code{operating-system} Reference
6853
6854 This section summarizes all the options available in
6855 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
6856 System}).
6857
6858 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
6859 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
6860 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
6861 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
6862
6863 @table @asis
6864 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
6865 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
6866 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
6867 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
6868
6869 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'()})
6870 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
6871 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
6872
6873 @item @code{bootloader}
6874 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{GRUB Configuration}.
6875
6876 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
6877 A two-argument monadic procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for
6878 the Linux kernel. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
6879
6880 @item @code{firmware} (default: @var{%base-firmware})
6881 @cindex firmware
6882 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
6883
6884 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros-based WiFi devices
6885 (Linux-libre module @code{ath9k}). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for
6886 more info on supported hardware.
6887
6888 @item @code{host-name}
6889 The host name.
6890
6891 @item @code{hosts-file}
6892 @cindex hosts file
6893 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
6894 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
6895 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
6896 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
6897
6898 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
6899 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
6900
6901 @item @code{file-systems}
6902 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
6903
6904 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
6905 @cindex swap devices
6906 A list of strings identifying devices to be used for ``swap space''
6907 (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6908 For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")}.
6909
6910 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
6911 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @var{%base-groups})
6912 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
6913
6914 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
6915 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6916 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
6917 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
6918
6919 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
6920
6921 @example
6922 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
6923 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
6924 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
6925 (activate-readline)")))
6926 @end example
6927
6928 @item @code{issue} (default: @var{%default-issue})
6929 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
6930 displayed when users log in on a text console.
6931
6932 @item @code{packages} (default: @var{%base-packages})
6933 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
6934 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
6935
6936 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
6937 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
6938 package}).
6939
6940 @item @code{timezone}
6941 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
6942
6943 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
6944 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
6945 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
6946
6947 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
6948 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
6949 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
6950
6951 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @var{%default-locale-definitions})
6952 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
6953 run time. @xref{Locales}.
6954
6955 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
6956 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
6957 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
6958 considerations that justify this option.
6959
6960 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @var{%default-nss})
6961 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
6962 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
6963 details.
6964
6965 @item @code{services} (default: @var{%base-services})
6966 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
6967
6968 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
6969 @cindex PAM
6970 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
6971 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
6972 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
6973
6974 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
6975 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
6976 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
6977
6978 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
6979 @cindex sudoers file
6980 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
6981 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
6982
6983 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
6984 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
6985 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
6986 @code{sudo}.
6987
6988 @end table
6989 @end deftp
6990
6991 @node File Systems
6992 @subsection File Systems
6993
6994 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
6995 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
6996 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
6997 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
6998
6999 @example
7000 (file-system
7001 (mount-point "/home")
7002 (device "/dev/sda3")
7003 (type "ext4"))
7004 @end example
7005
7006 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
7007 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
7008
7009 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
7010 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
7011 contain the following members:
7012
7013 @table @asis
7014 @item @code{type}
7015 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
7016 @code{"ext4"}.
7017
7018 @item @code{mount-point}
7019 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
7020
7021 @item @code{device}
7022 This names the ``source'' of the file system. By default it is the name
7023 of a node under @file{/dev}, but its meaning depends on the @code{title}
7024 field described below.
7025
7026 @item @code{title} (default: @code{'device})
7027 This is a symbol that specifies how the @code{device} field is to be
7028 interpreted.
7029
7030 When it is the symbol @code{device}, then the @code{device} field is
7031 interpreted as a file name; when it is @code{label}, then @code{device}
7032 is interpreted as a partition label name; when it is @code{uuid},
7033 @code{device} is interpreted as a partition unique identifier (UUID).
7034
7035 UUIDs may be converted from their string representation (as shown by the
7036 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
7037 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
7038 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
7039 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
7040 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
7041 like this:
7042
7043 @example
7044 (file-system
7045 (mount-point "/home")
7046 (type "ext4")
7047 (title 'uuid)
7048 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
7049 @end example
7050
7051 The @code{label} and @code{uuid} options offer a way to refer to disk
7052 partitions without having to hard-code their actual device
7053 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
7054 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
7055 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
7056 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
7057 mounted.}.
7058
7059 However, when the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
7060 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
7061 device name---e.g., @file{/dev/mapper/root-partition}---and consequently
7062 @code{title} must be set to @code{'device}. This is required so that
7063 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
7064 corresponding device mapping established.
7065
7066 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
7067 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
7068 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
7069 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
7070 bits), and @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution.)
7071
7072 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
7073 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options.
7074
7075 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
7076 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
7077 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
7078 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
7079 is not automatically mounted.
7080
7081 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
7082 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
7083 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
7084 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
7085 instance, for the root file system.
7086
7087 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
7088 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
7089 errors before being mounted.
7090
7091 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
7092 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
7093
7094 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
7095 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} objects representing file systems
7096 that must be mounted before (and unmounted after) this one.
7097
7098 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
7099 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
7100 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
7101
7102 @end table
7103 @end deftp
7104
7105 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
7106 variables.
7107
7108 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
7109 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
7110 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
7111 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
7112 these.
7113 @end defvr
7114
7115 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
7116 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
7117 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
7118 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
7119 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
7120 @command{xterm}.
7121 @end defvr
7122
7123 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
7124 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
7125 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
7126 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
7127 @end defvr
7128
7129 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
7130 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
7131 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
7132 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
7133 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
7134
7135 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
7136 read-write in its own ``name space.''
7137 @end defvr
7138
7139 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
7140 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
7141 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
7142 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
7143 @end defvr
7144
7145 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
7146 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
7147 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
7148 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
7149 @end defvr
7150
7151 @node Mapped Devices
7152 @subsection Mapped Devices
7153
7154 @cindex device mapping
7155 @cindex mapped devices
7156 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
7157 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
7158 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
7159 with additional processing over the data that flows through
7160 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
7161 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
7162 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
7163 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
7164 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
7165 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
7166 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
7167 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
7168 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
7169 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
7170 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
7171 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
7172 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
7173
7174 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
7175 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
7176
7177 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
7178 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
7179 the system boots up.
7180
7181 @table @code
7182 @item source
7183 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
7184 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
7185 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
7186
7187 @item target
7188 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
7189 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
7190 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
7191 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
7192 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
7193 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
7194
7195 @item type
7196 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
7197 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
7198 @end table
7199 @end deftp
7200
7201 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
7202 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
7203 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
7204 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
7205 @end defvr
7206
7207 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
7208 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
7209 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
7210 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
7211 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
7212 @end defvr
7213
7214 @cindex disk encryption
7215 @cindex LUKS
7216 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
7217 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
7218 @url{http://code.google.com/p/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
7219 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
7220 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
7221 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
7222 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
7223
7224 @example
7225 (mapped-device
7226 (source "/dev/sda3")
7227 (target "home")
7228 (type luks-device-mapping))
7229 @end example
7230
7231 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
7232 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
7233 command like:
7234
7235 @example
7236 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
7237 @end example
7238
7239 and use it as follows:
7240
7241 @example
7242 (mapped-device
7243 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
7244 (target "home")
7245 (type luks-device-mapping))
7246 @end example
7247
7248 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
7249 may be declared as follows:
7250
7251 @example
7252 (mapped-device
7253 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
7254 (target "/dev/md0")
7255 (type raid-device-mapping))
7256 @end example
7257
7258 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
7259 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
7260 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
7261 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
7262 automatically later.
7263
7264
7265 @node User Accounts
7266 @subsection User Accounts
7267
7268 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
7269 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
7270 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
7271
7272 @example
7273 (user-account
7274 (name "alice")
7275 (group "users")
7276 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
7277 "audio" ;sound card
7278 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
7279 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
7280 (comment "Bob's sister")
7281 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
7282 @end example
7283
7284 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
7285 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
7286 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
7287 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
7288 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
7289 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
7290 as declared.
7291
7292 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
7293 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
7294 be specified:
7295
7296 @table @asis
7297 @item @code{name}
7298 The name of the user account.
7299
7300 @item @code{group}
7301 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
7302 this account belongs to.
7303
7304 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
7305 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
7306 account belongs to.
7307
7308 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
7309 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
7310 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
7311 account is created.
7312
7313 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
7314 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
7315
7316 @item @code{home-directory}
7317 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
7318
7319 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
7320 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
7321 if it does not exist yet.
7322
7323 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
7324 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
7325 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
7326
7327 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
7328 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
7329 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
7330 graphical login managers do not list them.
7331
7332 @anchor{user-account-password}
7333 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
7334 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
7335 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
7336 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
7337 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
7338 reconfiguration.
7339
7340 If you @emph{do} want to have a preset password for an account, then
7341 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string.
7342 @xref{crypt,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for more information
7343 on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
7344 Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
7345
7346 @end table
7347 @end deftp
7348
7349 User group declarations are even simpler:
7350
7351 @example
7352 (user-group (name "students"))
7353 @end example
7354
7355 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
7356 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
7357
7358 @table @asis
7359 @item @code{name}
7360 The name of the group.
7361
7362 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
7363 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
7364 automatically allocated when the group is created.
7365
7366 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
7367 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
7368 System groups have low numerical IDs.
7369
7370 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
7371 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
7372 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
7373
7374 @end table
7375 @end deftp
7376
7377 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
7378 expect:
7379
7380 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
7381 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
7382 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
7383 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
7384 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
7385 @end defvr
7386
7387 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
7388 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
7389 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
7390
7391 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
7392 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
7393 @end defvr
7394
7395 @node Locales
7396 @subsection Locales
7397
7398 @cindex locale
7399 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
7400 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
7401 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
7402 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
7403 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
7404 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
7405
7406 @cindex locale definition
7407 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
7408 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
7409 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
7410
7411 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
7412 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
7413 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
7414 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
7415 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
7416 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
7417 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
7418 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
7419
7420 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
7421 that field may be:
7422
7423 @example
7424 (cons (locale-definition
7425 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
7426 %default-locale-definitions)
7427 @end example
7428
7429 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
7430 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
7431
7432 @example
7433 (list (locale-definition
7434 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
7435 (charset "EUC-JP")))
7436 @end example
7437
7438 @vindex LOCPATH
7439 The compiled locale definitions are available at
7440 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
7441 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
7442 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
7443 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
7444 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
7445
7446 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
7447 locale)} module. Details are given below.
7448
7449 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
7450 This is the data type of a locale definition.
7451
7452 @table @asis
7453
7454 @item @code{name}
7455 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
7456 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
7457
7458 @item @code{source}
7459 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
7460 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
7461
7462 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
7463 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
7464 @uref{http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
7465 IANA}.
7466
7467 @end table
7468 @end deftp
7469
7470 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
7471 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
7472 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
7473 declarations.
7474
7475 @cindex locale name
7476 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
7477 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
7478 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
7479 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
7480 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
7481 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
7482 @end defvr
7483
7484 @subsubsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
7485
7486 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
7487 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
7488 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
7489 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
7490 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
7491 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
7492 another.
7493
7494 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
7495 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
7496 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
7497 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
7498 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
7499 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
7500 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
7501 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
7502 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
7503 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
7504 programs will not abort.
7505
7506 The ``problem'' in GuixSD is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
7507 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
7508 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
7509 used to build the system-wide locale data.
7510
7511 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
7512 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
7513 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
7514
7515 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
7516 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
7517 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
7518 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
7519 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
7520 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
7521
7522 @example
7523 (use-package-modules base)
7524
7525 (operating-system
7526 ;; @dots{}
7527 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
7528 @end example
7529
7530 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
7531 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
7532 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
7533
7534
7535 @node Services
7536 @subsection Services
7537
7538 @cindex system services
7539 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
7540 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
7541 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
7542 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
7543 configuring network access.
7544
7545 GuixSD has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
7546 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
7547 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
7548 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
7549 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
7550 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
7551
7552 @example
7553 # herd status
7554 @end example
7555
7556 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
7557 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
7558 service:
7559
7560 @example
7561 # herd doc nscd
7562 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
7563 @end example
7564
7565 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
7566 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
7567 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
7568
7569 @example
7570 # herd stop nscd
7571 Service nscd has been stopped.
7572 # herd restart xorg-server
7573 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
7574 Service xorg-server has been started.
7575 @end example
7576
7577 The following sections document the available services, starting with
7578 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
7579 declaration.
7580
7581 @menu
7582 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
7583 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
7584 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
7585 * X Window:: Graphical display.
7586 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
7587 * Database Services:: SQL databases.
7588 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
7589 * Web Services:: Web servers.
7590 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
7591 @end menu
7592
7593 @node Base Services
7594 @subsubsection Base Services
7595
7596 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
7597 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
7598 this module are listed below.
7599
7600 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
7601 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
7602 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
7603 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
7604 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
7605 more.
7606
7607 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
7608 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
7609 system, you will want to append services to @var{%base-services}, like
7610 this:
7611
7612 @example
7613 (cons* (avahi-service) (lsh-service) %base-services)
7614 @end example
7615 @end defvr
7616
7617 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
7618 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
7619 @end deffn
7620
7621 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
7622 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
7623 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
7624 among other things.
7625 @end deffn
7626
7627 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
7628 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
7629
7630 @table @asis
7631
7632 @item @code{motd}
7633 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
7634
7635 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
7636 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
7637 the 'root' account has just been created.
7638
7639 @end table
7640 @end deftp
7641
7642 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
7643 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
7644 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
7645 other things.
7646 @end deffn
7647
7648 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
7649 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
7650 implements console log-in.
7651
7652 @table @asis
7653
7654 @item @code{tty}
7655 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
7656
7657 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
7658 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
7659 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
7660 user name and password must be entered to log in.
7661
7662 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
7663 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
7664 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
7665 the name of the log-in program.
7666
7667 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
7668 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
7669 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
7670
7671 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
7672 The Mingetty package to use.
7673
7674 @end table
7675 @end deftp
7676
7677 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
7678 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
7679 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
7680 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
7681 @end deffn
7682
7683 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
7684 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
7685 implements console log-in.
7686
7687 @table @asis
7688
7689 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
7690 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
7691
7692 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
7693 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
7694 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
7695
7696 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
7697 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
7698
7699 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
7700 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
7701
7702 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
7703 The Kmscon package to use.
7704
7705 @end table
7706 @end deftp
7707
7708 @cindex name service cache daemon
7709 @cindex nscd
7710 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
7711 [#:name-services '()]
7712 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
7713 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
7714 Service Switch}, for an example.
7715 @end deffn
7716
7717 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
7718 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
7719 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
7720 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
7721 @end defvr
7722
7723 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
7724 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
7725 configuration.
7726
7727 @table @asis
7728
7729 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
7730 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
7731 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
7732
7733 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
7734 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
7735 command.
7736
7737 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
7738 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
7739 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
7740
7741 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
7742 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
7743 debugging output is logged.
7744
7745 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
7746 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
7747 below.
7748
7749 @end table
7750 @end deftp
7751
7752 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
7753 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
7754
7755 @table @asis
7756
7757 @item @code{database}
7758 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
7759 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
7760 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
7761 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
7762
7763 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
7764 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
7765 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
7766 negative lookup result remains in cache.
7767
7768 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
7769 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
7770 @var{database}.
7771
7772 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
7773 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
7774 them into account.
7775
7776 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
7777 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
7778
7779 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
7780 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
7781
7782 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
7783 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
7784
7785 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
7786 @c settings, so leave them out.
7787
7788 @end table
7789 @end deftp
7790
7791 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
7792 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
7793 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
7794
7795 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
7796 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
7797 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
7798 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
7799 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
7800 @end defvr
7801
7802 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
7803 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
7804 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
7805
7806 @table @asis
7807 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
7808 The syslog daemon to use.
7809
7810 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
7811 The syslog configuration file to use.
7812
7813 @end table
7814 @end deftp
7815
7816 @anchor{syslog-service}
7817 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
7818 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
7819
7820 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
7821 information on the configuration file syntax.
7822 @end deffn
7823
7824 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
7825 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
7826 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
7827 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
7828
7829 @table @asis
7830 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
7831 The Guix package to use.
7832
7833 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
7834 Name of the group for build user accounts.
7835
7836 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
7837 Number of build user accounts to create.
7838
7839 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
7840 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
7841 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{hydra.gnu.org}
7842 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7843
7844 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
7845 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @var{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
7846 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
7847 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
7848 contains that of @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7849
7850 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
7851 Whether to use substitutes.
7852
7853 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @var{%default-substitute-urls})
7854 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
7855
7856 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
7857 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
7858
7859 @item @code{lsof} (default: @var{lsof})
7860 @itemx @code{lsh} (default: @var{lsh})
7861 The lsof and lsh packages to use.
7862
7863 @end table
7864 @end deftp
7865
7866 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-service @var{config}
7867 Return a service that runs the Guix build daemon according to
7868 @var{config}.
7869 @end deffn
7870
7871 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev udev]
7872 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
7873 @end deffn
7874
7875 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} urandom-seed-service @var{#f}
7876 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
7877 when rebooting.
7878 @end deffn
7879
7880 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
7881 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
7882 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
7883 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
7884 @end defvr
7885
7886 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} console-keymap-service @var{files} ...
7887 @cindex keyboard layout
7888 Return a service to load console keymaps from @var{files} using
7889 @command{loadkeys} command. Most likely, you want to load some default
7890 keymap, which can be done like this:
7891
7892 @example
7893 (console-keymap-service "dvorak")
7894 @end example
7895
7896 Or, for example, for a Swedish keyboard, you may need to combine
7897 the following keymaps:
7898 @example
7899 (console-keymap-service "se-lat6" "se-fi-lat6")
7900 @end example
7901
7902 Also you can specify a full file name (or file names) of your keymap(s).
7903 See @code{man loadkeys} for details.
7904
7905 @end deffn
7906
7907 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gpm-service [#:gpm @var{gpm}] @
7908 [#:options]
7909 Run @var{gpm}, the general-purpose mouse daemon, with the given
7910 command-line @var{options}. GPM allows users to use the mouse in the console,
7911 notably to select, copy, and paste text. The default value of @var{options}
7912 uses the @code{ps2} protocol, which works for both USB and PS/2 mice.
7913
7914 This service is not part of @var{%base-services}.
7915 @end deffn
7916
7917 @anchor{guix-publish-service}
7918 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-publish-service [#:guix @var{guix}] @
7919 [#:port 80] [#:host "localhost"]
7920 Return a service that runs @command{guix publish} listening on @var{host}
7921 and @var{port} (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
7922
7923 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
7924 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
7925 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
7926 @end deffn
7927
7928 @anchor{rngd-service}
7929 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
7930 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
7931 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
7932 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
7933 @var{device} does not exist.
7934 @end deffn
7935
7936 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
7937 @cindex session limits
7938 @cindex ulimit
7939 @cindex priority
7940 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @var{limits}]
7941
7942 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
7943 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
7944 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
7945 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
7946 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
7947
7948 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
7949 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
7950
7951 @example
7952 (pam-limits-service
7953 (list
7954 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
7955 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
7956 @end example
7957
7958 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
7959 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
7960 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
7961 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
7962 @end deffn
7963
7964 @node Scheduled Job Execution
7965 @subsubsection Scheduled Job Execution
7966
7967 @cindex cron
7968 @cindex scheduling jobs
7969 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
7970 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
7971 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
7972 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
7973 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
7974 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
7975
7976 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
7977 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
7978 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
7979 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
7980 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
7981 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
7982 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
7983
7984 @lisp
7985 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
7986 (use-package-modules base idutils)
7987
7988 (define updatedb-job
7989 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
7990 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
7991 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
7992 (lambda ()
7993 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
7994 "updatedb"
7995 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
7996
7997 (define garbage-collector-job
7998 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
7999 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
8000 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
8001 "guix gc -F 1G"))
8002
8003 (define idutils-job
8004 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
8005 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
8006 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
8007 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
8008 #:user "charlie"))
8009
8010 (operating-system
8011 ;; @dots{}
8012 (services (cons (mcron-service (list garbage-collector-job
8013 updatedb-job
8014 idutils-job))
8015 %base-services)))
8016 @end lisp
8017
8018 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
8019 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
8020 reference of the mcron service.
8021
8022 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mcron-service @var{jobs} [#:mcron @var{mcron2}]
8023 Return an mcron service running @var{mcron} that schedules @var{jobs}, a
8024 list of gexps denoting mcron job specifications.
8025
8026 This is a shorthand for:
8027 @example
8028 (service mcron-service-type
8029 (mcron-configuration (mcron mcron) (jobs jobs)))
8030 @end example
8031 @end deffn
8032
8033 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
8034 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
8035 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
8036
8037 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
8038 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
8039 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
8040 mcron jobs to run.
8041 @end defvr
8042
8043 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
8044 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
8045
8046 @table @asis
8047 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron2})
8048 The mcron package to use.
8049
8050 @item @code{jobs}
8051 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
8052 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
8053 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
8054 @end table
8055 @end deftp
8056
8057
8058 @node Networking Services
8059 @subsubsection Networking Services
8060
8061 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
8062 the network interface.
8063
8064 @cindex DHCP, networking service
8065 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcp-client-service [#:dhcp @var{isc-dhcp}]
8066 Return a service that runs @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
8067 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces.
8068 @end deffn
8069
8070 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
8071 [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}]
8072 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
8073 @var{gateway} is true, it must be a string specifying the default network
8074 gateway.
8075 @end deffn
8076
8077 @cindex wicd
8078 @cindex network management
8079 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
8080 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
8081 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
8082
8083 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
8084 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
8085 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
8086 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
8087 @end deffn
8088
8089 @cindex NetworkManager
8090 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} network-manager-service @
8091 [#:network-manager @var{network-manager}]
8092 Return a service that runs NetworkManager, a network connection manager
8093 attempting to keep network connectivity active when available.
8094 @end deffn
8095
8096 @cindex Connman
8097 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} connman-service @
8098 [#:connman @var{connman}]
8099 Return a service that runs @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman}, a network
8100 connection manager.
8101
8102 This service adds the @var{connman} package to the global profile, providing
8103 several the @command{connmanctl} command to interact with the daemon and
8104 configure networking."
8105 @end deffn
8106
8107 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} ntp-service [#:ntp @var{ntp}] @
8108 [#:servers @var{%ntp-servers}]
8109 Return a service that runs the daemon from @var{ntp}, the
8110 @uref{http://www.ntp.org, Network Time Protocol package}. The daemon will
8111 keep the system clock synchronized with that of @var{servers}.
8112 @end deffn
8113
8114 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
8115 List of host names used as the default NTP servers.
8116 @end defvr
8117
8118 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-service [@var{config-file}] [#:tor @var{tor}]
8119 Return a service to run the @uref{https://torproject.org, Tor} anonymous
8120 networking daemon.
8121
8122 The daemon runs as the @code{tor} unprivileged user. It is passed
8123 @var{config-file}, a file-like object, with an additional @code{User tor} line
8124 and lines for hidden services added via @code{tor-hidden-service}. Run
8125 @command{man tor} for information about the configuration file.
8126 @end deffn
8127
8128 @cindex hidden service
8129 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
8130 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
8131 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
8132
8133 @example
8134 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
8135 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
8136 @end example
8137
8138 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
8139 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
8140
8141 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
8142 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
8143 service.
8144
8145 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
8146 project's documentation} for more information.
8147 @end deffn
8148
8149 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bitlbee-service [#:bitlbee bitlbee] @
8150 [#:interface "127.0.0.1"] [#:port 6667] @
8151 [#:extra-settings ""]
8152 Return a service that runs @url{http://bitlbee.org,BitlBee}, a daemon that
8153 acts as a gateway between IRC and chat networks.
8154
8155 The daemon will listen to the interface corresponding to the IP address
8156 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}. @code{127.0.0.1} means that only
8157 local clients can connect, whereas @code{0.0.0.0} means that connections can
8158 come from any networking interface.
8159
8160 In addition, @var{extra-settings} specifies a string to append to the
8161 configuration file.
8162 @end deffn
8163
8164 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
8165
8166 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
8167 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
8168 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
8169 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
8170 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
8171 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
8172 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
8173 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
8174 only by root.
8175
8176 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
8177 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
8178 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
8179 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
8180 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
8181
8182 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
8183 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
8184 require interaction.
8185
8186 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
8187 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
8188 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
8189 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
8190
8191 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
8192 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
8193 or addresses.
8194
8195 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
8196 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
8197 root.
8198
8199 The other options should be self-descriptive.
8200 @end deffn
8201
8202 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
8203 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
8204 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
8205 object.
8206
8207 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
8208 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
8209
8210 @example
8211 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
8212 (port-number 1234)))
8213 @end example
8214 @end deffn
8215
8216 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
8217 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
8218
8219 @table @asis
8220 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
8221 The Dropbear package to use.
8222
8223 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
8224 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
8225
8226 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
8227 Whether to enable syslog output.
8228
8229 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
8230 File name of the daemon's PID file.
8231
8232 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
8233 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
8234
8235 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
8236 Whether to allow empty passwords.
8237
8238 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
8239 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
8240 @end table
8241 @end deftp
8242
8243 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
8244 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
8245 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
8246 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
8247 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
8248 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
8249
8250 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
8251 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
8252 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
8253
8254 @example
8255 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
8256
8257 (operating-system
8258 (host-name "mymachine")
8259 ;; ...
8260 (hosts-file
8261 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
8262 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
8263 (plain-file "hosts"
8264 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
8265 %facebook-host-aliases))))
8266 @end example
8267
8268 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
8269 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
8270 @end defvr
8271
8272 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
8273
8274 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} avahi-service [#:avahi @var{avahi}] @
8275 [#:host-name #f] [#:publish? #t] [#:ipv4? #t] @
8276 [#:ipv6? #t] [#:wide-area? #f] @
8277 [#:domains-to-browse '()] [#:debug? #f]
8278 Return a service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
8279 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
8280 "zero-configuration" host name lookups (see @uref{http://avahi.org/}), and
8281 extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can resolve
8282 @code{.local} host names using
8283 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. Additionally,
8284 add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that commands such as
8285 @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
8286
8287 If @var{host-name} is different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
8288 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
8289
8290 When @var{publish?} is true, publishing of host names and services is allowed;
8291 in particular, avahi-daemon will publish the machine's host name and IP
8292 address via mDNS on the local network.
8293
8294 When @var{wide-area?} is true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
8295
8296 Boolean values @var{ipv4?} and @var{ipv6?} determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6
8297 sockets.
8298 @end deffn
8299
8300
8301 @node X Window
8302 @subsubsection X Window
8303
8304 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
8305 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
8306 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
8307 started by the @dfn{login manager}, currently SLiM.
8308
8309 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
8310 This is the data type representing the sddm service configuration.
8311
8312 @table @asis
8313 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
8314 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are "x11"
8315 or "wayland".
8316
8317 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
8318 Valid values are "on", "off" or "none".
8319
8320 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
8321 Command to run when halting.
8322
8323 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
8324 Command to run when rebooting.
8325
8326 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
8327 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are "elarun" or "maldives".
8328
8329 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
8330 Directory to look for themes.
8331
8332 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
8333 Directory to look for faces.
8334
8335 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
8336 Default PATH to use.
8337
8338 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default 1000)
8339 Minimum UID to display in SDDM.
8340
8341 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default 2000)
8342 Maximum UID to display in SDDM
8343
8344 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
8345 Remember last user.
8346
8347 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
8348 Remember last session.
8349
8350 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
8351 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
8352
8353 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
8354 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
8355
8356 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
8357 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
8358
8359 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
8360 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
8361
8362 @item @code{xorg-server-path} (default @code{xorg-start-command})
8363 Path to xorg-server.
8364
8365 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
8366 Path to xauth.
8367
8368 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
8369 Path to Xephyr.
8370
8371 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
8372 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
8373
8374 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
8375 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
8376
8377 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitr })
8378 Script to run before starting a X session.
8379
8380 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
8381 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
8382
8383 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
8384 Minimum VT to use.
8385
8386 @item @code{xserver-arguments} (default "-nolisten tcp")
8387 Arguments to pass to xorg-server.
8388
8389 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
8390 User to use for auto-login.
8391
8392 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
8393 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
8394
8395 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
8396 Relogin after logout.
8397
8398 @end table
8399 @end deftp
8400
8401 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sddm-service config
8402 Return a service that spawns the SDDM graphical login manager for config of
8403 type @code{<sddm-configuration>}.
8404
8405 @example
8406 (sddm-service (sddm-configuration
8407 (auto-login-user "Alice")
8408 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
8409 @end example
8410 @end deffn
8411
8412 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} slim-service [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] @
8413 [#:auto-login? #f] [#:default-user ""] [#:startx] @
8414 [#:theme @var{%default-slim-theme}] @
8415 [#:theme-name @var{%default-slim-theme-name}]
8416 Return a service that spawns the SLiM graphical login manager, which in
8417 turn starts the X display server with @var{startx}, a command as returned by
8418 @code{xorg-start-command}.
8419
8420 @cindex X session
8421
8422 SLiM automatically looks for session types described by the @file{.desktop}
8423 files in @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users
8424 to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. Packages such as
8425 @var{xfce}, @var{sawfish}, and @var{ratpoison} provide @file{.desktop} files;
8426 adding them to the system-wide set of packages automatically makes them
8427 available at the log-in screen.
8428
8429 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
8430 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
8431 and/or other X clients.
8432
8433 When @var{allow-empty-passwords?} is true, allow logins with an empty
8434 password. When @var{auto-login?} is true, log in automatically as
8435 @var{default-user}.
8436
8437 If @var{theme} is @code{#f}, use the default log-in theme; otherwise
8438 @var{theme} must be a gexp denoting the name of a directory containing the
8439 theme to use. In that case, @var{theme-name} specifies the name of the
8440 theme.
8441 @end deffn
8442
8443 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
8444 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
8445 The G-Expression denoting the default SLiM theme and its name.
8446 @end defvr
8447
8448 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [#:guile] @
8449 [#:configuration-file #f] [#:xorg-server @var{xorg-server}]
8450 Return a derivation that builds a @var{guile} script to start the X server
8451 from @var{xorg-server}. @var{configuration-file} is the server configuration
8452 file or a derivation that builds it; when omitted, the result of
8453 @code{xorg-configuration-file} is used.
8454
8455 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
8456 @end deffn
8457
8458 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-configuration-file @
8459 [#:drivers '()] [#:resolutions '()] [#:extra-config '()]
8460 Return a configuration file for the Xorg server containing search paths for
8461 all the common drivers.
8462
8463 @var{drivers} must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a
8464 graphics driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in
8465 this order---e.g., @code{(\"modesetting\" \"vesa\")}.
8466
8467 Likewise, when @var{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an
8468 appropriate screen resolution; otherwise, it must be a list of
8469 resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024 768) (640 480))}.
8470
8471 Last, @var{extra-config} is a list of strings or objects appended to the
8472 @code{text-file*} argument list. It is used to pass extra text to be added
8473 verbatim to the configuration file.
8474 @end deffn
8475
8476 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{name}]
8477 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen-locker or screen-saver whose
8478 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
8479 for it. For example:
8480
8481 @lisp
8482 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
8483 @end lisp
8484
8485 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
8486 @end deffn
8487
8488
8489 @node Desktop Services
8490 @subsubsection Desktop Services
8491
8492 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
8493 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
8494 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
8495 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
8496 environments like GNOME and XFCE.
8497
8498 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
8499 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
8500 environment and networking:
8501
8502 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
8503 This is a list of services that builds upon @var{%base-services} and
8504 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
8505
8506 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
8507 @code{slim-service}}), screen lockers,
8508 a network management tool (@pxref{Networking
8509 Services, @code{wicd-service}}), energy and color management services,
8510 the @code{elogind} login and seat manager, the Polkit privilege service,
8511 the GeoClue location service, an NTP client (@pxref{Networking
8512 Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the name service switch service
8513 configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns} (@pxref{Name Service
8514 Switch, mDNS}).
8515 @end defvr
8516
8517 The @var{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
8518 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
8519 Reference, @code{services}}).
8520
8521 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service} and
8522 @code{xfce-desktop-service} procedures can add GNOME and/or XFCE to a
8523 system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level services like the
8524 backlight adjustment helpers and the power management utilities are
8525 added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
8526 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
8527 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
8528 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service} adds the GNOME
8529 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the XFCE service
8530 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
8531 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
8532 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
8533 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
8534
8535 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gnome-desktop-service
8536 Return a service that adds the @code{gnome} package to the system
8537 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
8538 @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
8539 @end deffn
8540
8541 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xfce-desktop-service
8542 Return a service that adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile,
8543 and extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the
8544 file system as root from within a user session, after the user has
8545 authenticated with the administrator's password.
8546 @end deffn
8547
8548 Because the GNOME and XFCE desktop services pull in so many packages,
8549 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include either of
8550 them by default. To add GNOME or XFCE, just @code{cons} them onto
8551 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
8552 @code{operating-system}:
8553
8554 @example
8555 (use-modules (gnu))
8556 (use-service-modules desktop)
8557 (operating-system
8558 ...
8559 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
8560 (services (cons* (gnome-desktop-service)
8561 (xfce-desktop-service)
8562 %desktop-services))
8563 ...)
8564 @end example
8565
8566 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
8567 graphical login window.
8568
8569 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
8570 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
8571 are described below.
8572
8573 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
8574 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
8575 support for @var{services}.
8576
8577 @uref{http://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
8578 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
8579 and to be notified of system-wide events.
8580
8581 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
8582 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
8583 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
8584 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
8585 @end deffn
8586
8587 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
8588 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
8589 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/andywingo/elogind,
8590 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
8591 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
8592 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
8593
8594 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
8595 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
8596 when the power button is pressed.
8597
8598 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
8599 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
8600 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
8601 their default values are:
8602
8603 @table @code
8604 @item kill-user-processes?
8605 @code{#f}
8606 @item kill-only-users
8607 @code{()}
8608 @item kill-exclude-users
8609 @code{("root")}
8610 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
8611 @code{5}
8612 @item handle-power-key
8613 @code{poweroff}
8614 @item handle-suspend-key
8615 @code{suspend}
8616 @item handle-hibernate-key
8617 @code{hibernate}
8618 @item handle-lid-switch
8619 @code{suspend}
8620 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
8621 @code{ignore}
8622 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
8623 @code{#f}
8624 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
8625 @code{#f}
8626 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
8627 @code{#f}
8628 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
8629 @code{#t}
8630 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
8631 @code{30}
8632 @item idle-action
8633 @code{ignore}
8634 @item idle-action-seconds
8635 @code{(* 30 60)}
8636 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
8637 @code{10}
8638 @item runtime-directory-size
8639 @code{#f}
8640 @item remove-ipc?
8641 @code{#t}
8642 @item suspend-state
8643 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
8644 @item suspend-mode
8645 @code{()}
8646 @item hibernate-state
8647 @code{("disk")}
8648 @item hibernate-mode
8649 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
8650 @item hybrid-sleep-state
8651 @code{("disk")}
8652 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
8653 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
8654 @end table
8655 @end deffn
8656
8657 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
8658 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
8659 Return a service that runs the
8660 @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
8661 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
8662 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
8663 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
8664 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
8665 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
8666 @end deffn
8667
8668 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} upower-service [#:upower @var{upower}] @
8669 [#:watts-up-pro? #f] @
8670 [#:poll-batteries? #t] @
8671 [#:ignore-lid? #f] @
8672 [#:use-percentage-for-policy? #f] @
8673 [#:percentage-low 10] @
8674 [#:percentage-critical 3] @
8675 [#:percentage-action 2] @
8676 [#:time-low 1200] @
8677 [#:time-critical 300] @
8678 [#:time-action 120] @
8679 [#:critical-power-action 'hybrid-sleep]
8680 Return a service that runs @uref{http://upower.freedesktop.org/,
8681 @command{upowerd}}, a system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery
8682 levels, with the given configuration settings. It implements the
8683 @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is notably used by
8684 GNOME.
8685 @end deffn
8686
8687 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
8688 Return a service for @uref{http://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
8689 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
8690 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
8691 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
8692 @end deffn
8693
8694 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
8695 Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
8696 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
8697 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
8698 tool. See @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
8699 site} for more information.
8700 @end deffn
8701
8702 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
8703 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
8704 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
8705 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
8706 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
8707 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
8708 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
8709 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
8710 means that all users are allowed.
8711 @end deffn
8712
8713 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
8714 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
8715 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
8716 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
8717 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
8718 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
8719 know the user's location.
8720 @end defvr
8721
8722 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
8723 [#:whitelist '()] @
8724 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
8725 [#:submit-data? #f]
8726 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
8727 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
8728 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
8729 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
8730 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
8731 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
8732 location databases. See
8733 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
8734 web site} for more information.
8735 @end deffn
8736
8737 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}]
8738 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which manages
8739 all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus interfaces.
8740
8741 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
8742 @end deffn
8743
8744 @node Database Services
8745 @subsubsection Database Services
8746
8747 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
8748
8749 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
8750 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data'']
8751 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
8752 server.
8753
8754 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from
8755 @var{config-file} and stores the database cluster in
8756 @var{data-directory}.
8757 @end deffn
8758
8759 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
8760 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
8761 database server.
8762
8763 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
8764 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuraiton>} object.
8765 @end deffn
8766
8767 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
8768 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
8769
8770 @table @asis
8771 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
8772 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
8773 or @var{mysql}.
8774
8775 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
8776 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
8777 @end table
8778 @end deftp
8779
8780 @node Mail Services
8781 @subsubsection Mail Services
8782
8783 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
8784 for mail services. Currently the only implemented service is Dovecot,
8785 an IMAP, POP3, and LMTP server.
8786
8787 Guix does not yet have a mail transfer agent (MTA), although for some
8788 lightweight purposes the @code{esmtp} relay-only MTA may suffice. Help
8789 is needed to properly integrate a full MTA, such as Postfix. Patches
8790 welcome!
8791
8792 To add an IMAP/POP3 server to a GuixSD system, add a
8793 @code{dovecot-service} to the operating system definition:
8794
8795 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
8796 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
8797 @end deffn
8798
8799 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
8800 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
8801 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
8802 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
8803 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
8804 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
8805 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
8806 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
8807
8808 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
8809 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
8810
8811 @example
8812 (dovecot-service #:config
8813 (dovecot-configuration
8814 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
8815 @end example
8816
8817 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
8818 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
8819 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
8820 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
8821 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
8822 from some other system; see the end for more details.
8823
8824 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
8825 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
8826 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
8827 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
8828 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
8829 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
8830 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
8831
8832 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
8833
8834 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
8835 The dovecot package.
8836 @end deftypevr
8837
8838 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
8839 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
8840 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
8841 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
8842 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
8843 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
8844 @end deftypevr
8845
8846 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
8847 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
8848 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
8849
8850 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
8851
8852 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
8853 The name of the protocol.
8854 @end deftypevr
8855
8856 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
8857 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
8858 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
8859 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
8860 @end deftypevr
8861
8862 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
8863 Space separated list of plugins to load.
8864 @end deftypevr
8865
8866 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
8867 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
8868 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
8869 Defaults to @samp{10}.
8870 @end deftypevr
8871
8872 @end deftypevr
8873
8874 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
8875 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
8876 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
8877 @samp{lmtp}.
8878
8879 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
8880
8881 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
8882 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
8883 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
8884 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
8885 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
8886 @end deftypevr
8887
8888 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
8889 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
8890 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
8891 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
8892 Defaults to @samp{()}.
8893
8894 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
8895
8896 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
8897 The file name on which to listen.
8898 @end deftypevr
8899
8900 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
8901 The access mode for the socket.
8902 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
8903 @end deftypevr
8904
8905 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
8906 The user to own the socket.
8907 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8908 @end deftypevr
8909
8910 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
8911 The group to own the socket.
8912 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8913 @end deftypevr
8914
8915
8916 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
8917
8918 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
8919 The file name on which to listen.
8920 @end deftypevr
8921
8922 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
8923 The access mode for the socket.
8924 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
8925 @end deftypevr
8926
8927 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
8928 The user to own the socket.
8929 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8930 @end deftypevr
8931
8932 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
8933 The group to own the socket.
8934 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8935 @end deftypevr
8936
8937
8938 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
8939
8940 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
8941 The protocol to listen for.
8942 @end deftypevr
8943
8944 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
8945 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
8946 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8947 @end deftypevr
8948
8949 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
8950 The port on which to listen.
8951 @end deftypevr
8952
8953 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
8954 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
8955 @samp{required}.
8956 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8957 @end deftypevr
8958
8959 @end deftypevr
8960
8961 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
8962 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
8963 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
8964 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
8965 Defaults to @samp{1}.
8966 @end deftypevr
8967
8968 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
8969 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
8970 Defaults to @samp{0}.
8971 @end deftypevr
8972
8973 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
8974 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
8975 this.
8976 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
8977 @end deftypevr
8978
8979 @end deftypevr
8980
8981 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
8982 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
8983 constructor.
8984
8985 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
8986
8987 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
8988 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
8989 Defaults to @samp{()}.
8990 @end deftypevr
8991
8992 @end deftypevr
8993
8994 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
8995 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
8996 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
8997
8998 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
8999
9000 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
9001 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
9002 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
9003 @samp{static}.
9004 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
9005 @end deftypevr
9006
9007 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
9008 A list of key-value args to the passdb driver.
9009 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9010 @end deftypevr
9011
9012 @end deftypevr
9013
9014 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
9015 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
9016 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
9017
9018 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
9019
9020 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
9021 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
9022 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
9023 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
9024 @end deftypevr
9025
9026 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
9027 A list of key-value args to the userdb driver.
9028 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9029 @end deftypevr
9030
9031 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
9032 Override fields from passwd.
9033 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9034 @end deftypevr
9035
9036 @end deftypevr
9037
9038 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
9039 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
9040 constructor.
9041 @end deftypevr
9042
9043 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
9044 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
9045 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
9046
9047 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
9048
9049 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
9050 Name for this namespace.
9051 @end deftypevr
9052
9053 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
9054 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
9055 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
9056 @end deftypevr
9057
9058 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
9059 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
9060 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
9061 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
9062 format.
9063 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9064 @end deftypevr
9065
9066 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
9067 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
9068 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
9069 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9070 @end deftypevr
9071
9072 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
9073 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
9074 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
9075 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9076 @end deftypevr
9077
9078 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
9079 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
9080 namespace has it.
9081 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9082 @end deftypevr
9083
9084 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
9085 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
9086 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
9087 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
9088 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
9089 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
9090 and @samp{mail/}.
9091 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9092 @end deftypevr
9093
9094 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
9095 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
9096 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
9097 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
9098 hides the namespace prefix.
9099 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9100 @end deftypevr
9101
9102 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
9103 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
9104 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
9105 as @code{#t}).
9106 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9107 @end deftypevr
9108
9109 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
9110 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
9111 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9112
9113 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
9114
9115 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
9116 Name for this mailbox.
9117 @end deftypevr
9118
9119 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
9120 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
9121 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
9122 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
9123 @end deftypevr
9124
9125 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
9126 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
9127 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
9128 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
9129 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9130 @end deftypevr
9131
9132 @end deftypevr
9133
9134 @end deftypevr
9135
9136 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
9137 Base directory where to store runtime data.
9138 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
9139 @end deftypevr
9140
9141 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
9142 Greeting message for clients.
9143 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
9144 @end deftypevr
9145
9146 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
9147 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
9148 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
9149 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
9150 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
9151 here.
9152 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9153 @end deftypevr
9154
9155 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
9156 List of login access check sockets (e.g. tcpwrap).
9157 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9158 @end deftypevr
9159
9160 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
9161 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
9162 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
9163 processes (e.g. shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
9164 accounts).
9165 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9166 @end deftypevr
9167
9168 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
9169 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
9170 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
9171 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
9172 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g. due to a security fix).
9173 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9174 @end deftypevr
9175
9176 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
9177 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
9178 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
9179 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9180 @end deftypevr
9181
9182 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
9183 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
9184 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
9185 @end deftypevr
9186
9187 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
9188 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
9189 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
9190 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
9191 @end deftypevr
9192
9193 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
9194 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
9195 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
9196 matches the local IP (i.e. you're connecting from the same computer),
9197 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
9198 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
9199 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9200 @end deftypevr
9201
9202 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
9203 Authentication cache size (e.g. @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
9204 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
9205 for caching to be used.
9206 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9207 @end deftypevr
9208
9209 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
9210 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
9211 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
9212 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
9213 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
9214 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
9215 authentication.
9216 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
9217 @end deftypevr
9218
9219 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
9220 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
9221 0 disables caching them completely.
9222 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
9223 @end deftypevr
9224
9225 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
9226 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
9227 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
9228 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
9229 realm first.
9230 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9231 @end deftypevr
9232
9233 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
9234 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
9235 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
9236 logins.
9237 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9238 @end deftypevr
9239
9240 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
9241 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
9242 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
9243 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
9244 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
9245 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
9246 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
9247 @end deftypevr
9248
9249 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
9250 Username character translations before it's looked up from
9251 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
9252 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
9253 translated to @samp{@@}.
9254 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9255 @end deftypevr
9256
9257 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
9258 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
9259 use the standard variables here, e.g. %Lu would lowercase the username,
9260 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
9261 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
9262 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
9263 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
9264 @end deftypevr
9265
9266 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
9267 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
9268 username within the normal username string (i.e. not using SASL
9269 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
9270 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
9271 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
9272 choice.
9273 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9274 @end deftypevr
9275
9276 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
9277 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
9278 mechanism.
9279 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
9280 @end deftypevr
9281
9282 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
9283 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
9284 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g. MySQL and PAM).
9285 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
9286 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9287 @end deftypevr
9288
9289 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
9290 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
9291 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
9292 allow all keytab entries.
9293 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9294 @end deftypevr
9295
9296 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
9297 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
9298 system default (usually /etc/krb5.keytab) if not specified. You may
9299 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
9300 file.
9301 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9302 @end deftypevr
9303
9304 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
9305 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
9306 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
9307 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
9308 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9309 @end deftypevr
9310
9311 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
9312 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
9313 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
9314 @end deftypevr
9315
9316 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
9317 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
9318 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
9319 @end deftypevr
9320
9321 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
9322 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
9323 fails.
9324 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9325 @end deftypevr
9326
9327 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
9328 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
9329 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
9330 CommonName.
9331 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9332 @end deftypevr
9333
9334 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
9335 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
9336 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
9337 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
9338 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
9339 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
9340 @end deftypevr
9341
9342 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
9343 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
9344 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
9345 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
9346 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9347 @end deftypevr
9348
9349 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
9350 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
9351 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
9352 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9353 @end deftypevr
9354
9355 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
9356 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
9357 has any connections.
9358 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
9359 @end deftypevr
9360
9361 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer director-doveadm-port
9362 TCP/IP port that accepts doveadm connections (instead of director
9363 connections) If you enable this, you'll also need to add
9364 @samp{inet-listener} for the port.
9365 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9366 @end deftypevr
9367
9368 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
9369 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
9370 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
9371 are shared within domain.
9372 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
9373 @end deftypevr
9374
9375 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
9376 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
9377 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
9378 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
9379 @end deftypevr
9380
9381 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
9382 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
9383 @samp{log-path}.
9384 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9385 @end deftypevr
9386
9387 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
9388 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
9389 @samp{info-log-path}.
9390 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9391 @end deftypevr
9392
9393 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
9394 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
9395 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
9396 standard facilities are supported.
9397 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
9398 @end deftypevr
9399
9400 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
9401 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
9402 failed.
9403 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9404 @end deftypevr
9405
9406 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose-passwords?
9407 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
9408 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
9409 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
9410 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
9411 ":n" (e.g. sha1:6).
9412 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9413 @end deftypevr
9414
9415 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
9416 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
9417 SQL queries.
9418 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9419 @end deftypevr
9420
9421 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
9422 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
9423 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
9424 @samp{auth-debug}.
9425 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9426 @end deftypevr
9427
9428 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
9429 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
9430 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
9431 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9432 @end deftypevr
9433
9434 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
9435 Show protocol level SSL errors.
9436 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9437 @end deftypevr
9438
9439 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
9440 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
9441 strftime(3) format.
9442 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
9443 @end deftypevr
9444
9445 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
9446 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
9447 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
9448 string.
9449 @end deftypevr
9450
9451 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
9452 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
9453 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
9454 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
9455 @end deftypevr
9456
9457 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
9458 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
9459 of possible variables you can use.
9460 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u): \""}.
9461 @end deftypevr
9462
9463 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
9464 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
9465 @table @code
9466 @item %$
9467 Delivery status message (e.g. @samp{saved to INBOX})
9468 @item %m
9469 Message-ID
9470 @item %s
9471 Subject
9472 @item %f
9473 From address
9474 @item %p
9475 Physical size
9476 @item %w
9477 Virtual size.
9478 @end table
9479 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
9480 @end deftypevr
9481
9482 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
9483 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
9484 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
9485 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
9486 Dovecot the full location.
9487
9488 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
9489 file (e.g. /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
9490 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
9491 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
9492 @samp{mail-location} setting.
9493
9494 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
9495
9496 @table @samp
9497 @item %u
9498 username
9499 @item %n
9500 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
9501 @item %d
9502 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
9503 @item %h
9504 home director
9505 @end table
9506
9507 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
9508 @table @samp
9509 @item maildir:~/Maildir
9510 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
9511 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
9512 @end table
9513 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9514 @end deftypevr
9515
9516 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
9517 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
9518 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
9519 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
9520 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9521 @end deftypevr
9522
9523 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
9524
9525 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9526 @end deftypevr
9527
9528 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
9529 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
9530 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
9531 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
9532 /var/mail.
9533 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9534 @end deftypevr
9535
9536 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
9537 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
9538 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
9539 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
9540 symlinks (e.g. if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
9541 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
9542 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
9543 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9544 @end deftypevr
9545
9546 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
9547 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
9548 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
9549 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
9550 names with e.g. /path/ or ~user/.
9551 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9552 @end deftypevr
9553
9554 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
9555 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
9556 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
9557 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9558 @end deftypevr
9559
9560 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
9561 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
9562 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
9563 nowadays by default.
9564 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9565 @end deftypevr
9566
9567 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
9568 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
9569 @table @code
9570 @item optimized
9571 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
9572 @item always
9573 Useful with e.g. NFS when write()s are delayed
9574 @item never
9575 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
9576 @end table
9577 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
9578 @end deftypevr
9579
9580 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
9581 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
9582 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
9583 this isn't needed.
9584 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9585 @end deftypevr
9586
9587 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
9588 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
9589 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
9590 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9591 @end deftypevr
9592
9593 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
9594 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
9595 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
9596 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
9597 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
9598 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
9599 @end deftypevr
9600
9601 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
9602 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
9603 kB.
9604 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
9605 @end deftypevr
9606
9607 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
9608 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
9609 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
9610 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
9611 is set to 0.
9612 Defaults to @samp{500}.
9613 @end deftypevr
9614
9615 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
9616
9617 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9618 @end deftypevr
9619
9620 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
9621 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
9622 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
9623 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
9624 Defaults to @samp{1}.
9625 @end deftypevr
9626
9627 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
9628
9629 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9630 @end deftypevr
9631
9632 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
9633 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
9634 trying to create new keywords.
9635 Defaults to @samp{50}.
9636 @end deftypevr
9637
9638 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
9639 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
9640 processes (i.e. /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
9641 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
9642 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
9643 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
9644 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
9645 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
9646 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
9647 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9648 @end deftypevr
9649
9650 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
9651 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
9652 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
9653 directory (e.g. /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
9654 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
9655 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
9656 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/." to
9657 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
9658 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9659 @end deftypevr
9660
9661 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
9662 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
9663 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
9664 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
9665 @end deftypevr
9666
9667 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
9668 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
9669 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
9670 @end deftypevr
9671
9672 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
9673 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
9674 LDA, etc. are added to this list in their own .conf files.
9675 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9676 @end deftypevr
9677
9678 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
9679 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
9680 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
9681 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
9682 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9683 @end deftypevr
9684
9685 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
9686 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
9687 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
9688 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
9689 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
9690 occur.
9691 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
9692 @end deftypevr
9693
9694 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
9695 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
9696 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
9697 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
9698 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
9699 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
9700 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9701 @end deftypevr
9702
9703 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
9704 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
9705 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
9706 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
9707 causes more disk I/O.
9708 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
9709 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
9710 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9711 @end deftypevr
9712
9713 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
9714 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
9715 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
9716 side effects.
9717 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9718 @end deftypevr
9719
9720 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
9721 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
9722 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
9723 the mail otherwise.
9724 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9725 @end deftypevr
9726
9727 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
9728 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
9729 available:
9730
9731 @table @code
9732 @item dotlock
9733 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
9734 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
9735 need write access to that directory.
9736 @item dotlock-try
9737 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
9738 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
9739 @item fcntl
9740 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
9741 @item flock
9742 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
9743 @item lockf
9744 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
9745 @end table
9746
9747 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
9748 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
9749 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
9750 them simultaneously.
9751 @end deftypevr
9752
9753 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
9754
9755 @end deftypevr
9756
9757 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
9758 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
9759 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
9760 @end deftypevr
9761
9762 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
9763 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
9764 override the lock file after this much time.
9765 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
9766 @end deftypevr
9767
9768 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
9769 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
9770 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
9771 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
9772 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
9773 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
9774 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
9775 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
9776 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
9777 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
9778 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9779 @end deftypevr
9780
9781 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
9782 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
9783 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
9784 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
9785 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9786 @end deftypevr
9787
9788 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
9789 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
9790 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
9791 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
9792 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
9793 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9794 @end deftypevr
9795
9796 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
9797 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g. 100k), don't write index
9798 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
9799 updated.
9800 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9801 @end deftypevr
9802
9803 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
9804 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
9805 Defaults to @samp{2000000}.
9806 @end deftypevr
9807
9808 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
9809 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
9810 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
9811 disabled.
9812 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
9813 @end deftypevr
9814
9815 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
9816 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
9817 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
9818 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
9819 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9820 @end deftypevr
9821
9822 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
9823 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
9824 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
9825 don't support this for now.
9826
9827 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
9828
9829 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
9830 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9831 @end deftypevr
9832
9833 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
9834 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
9835 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
9836 externally.
9837 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
9838 @end deftypevr
9839
9840 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
9841 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
9842 @table @code
9843 @item posix
9844 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
9845 @item sis posix
9846 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
9847 @item sis-queue posix
9848 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
9849 @end table
9850 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
9851 @end deftypevr
9852
9853 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
9854 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
9855 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
9856 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
9857 truncated, e.g. @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
9858 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
9859 @end deftypevr
9860
9861 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
9862
9863 Defaults to @samp{100}.
9864 @end deftypevr
9865
9866 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
9867
9868 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
9869 @end deftypevr
9870
9871 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
9872 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
9873 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
9874 before they eat up everything.
9875 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
9876 @end deftypevr
9877
9878 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
9879 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
9880 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
9881 at all.
9882 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
9883 @end deftypevr
9884
9885 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
9886 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
9887 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
9888 processes.
9889 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
9890 @end deftypevr
9891
9892 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
9893 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
9894 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
9895 @end deftypevr
9896
9897 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
9898 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
9899 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
9900 @end deftypevr
9901
9902 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
9903 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
9904 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
9905 root.
9906 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
9907 @end deftypevr
9908
9909 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
9910 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
9911 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
9912 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
9913 instead to a different.
9914 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9915 @end deftypevr
9916
9917 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
9918 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
9919 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
9920 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
9921 CRL(s). (e.g. @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
9922 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9923 @end deftypevr
9924
9925 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
9926 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
9927 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9928 @end deftypevr
9929
9930 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
9931 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
9932 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
9933 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9934 @end deftypevr
9935
9936 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
9937 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
9938 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
9939 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
9940 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
9941 @end deftypevr
9942
9943 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} hours ssl-parameters-regenerate
9944 How often to regenerate the SSL parameters file. Generation is
9945 quite CPU intensive operation. The value is in hours, 0 disables
9946 regeneration entirely.
9947 Defaults to @samp{168}.
9948 @end deftypevr
9949
9950 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-protocols
9951 SSL protocols to use.
9952 Defaults to @samp{"!SSLv2"}.
9953 @end deftypevr
9954
9955 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
9956 SSL ciphers to use.
9957 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!LOW:!SSLv2:!EXP:!aNULL"}.
9958 @end deftypevr
9959
9960 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
9961 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
9962 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9963 @end deftypevr
9964
9965 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
9966 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
9967 Default is postmaster@@<your domain>. %d expands to recipient domain.
9968 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9969 @end deftypevr
9970
9971 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
9972 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g. in Message-Id)
9973 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
9974 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9975 @end deftypevr
9976
9977 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
9978 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
9979 bouncing the mail.
9980 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9981 @end deftypevr
9982
9983 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
9984 Binary to use for sending mails.
9985 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
9986 @end deftypevr
9987
9988 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
9989 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
9990 sendmail.
9991 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9992 @end deftypevr
9993
9994 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
9995 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
9996 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
9997 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
9998 @end deftypevr
9999
10000 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
10001 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
10002 variables:
10003
10004 @table @code
10005 @item %n
10006 CRLF
10007 @item %r
10008 reason
10009 @item %s
10010 original subject
10011 @item %t
10012 recipient
10013 @end table
10014 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
10015 @end deftypevr
10016
10017 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
10018 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
10019 address.
10020 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
10021 @end deftypevr
10022
10023 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
10024 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
10025 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
10026 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
10027 X-Original-To.
10028 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10029 @end deftypevr
10030
10031 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
10032 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
10033 it?.
10034 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10035 @end deftypevr
10036
10037 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
10038 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
10039 subscribed?.
10040 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10041 @end deftypevr
10042
10043 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
10044 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
10045 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
10046 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
10047 often.
10048 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
10049 @end deftypevr
10050
10051 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
10052 IMAP logout format string:
10053 @table @code
10054 @item %i
10055 total number of bytes read from client
10056 @item %o
10057 total number of bytes sent to client.
10058 @end table
10059 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o"}.
10060 @end deftypevr
10061
10062 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
10063 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
10064 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g. +XFOO XBAR).
10065 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10066 @end deftypevr
10067
10068 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
10069 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
10070 is IDLEing.
10071 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
10072 @end deftypevr
10073
10074 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
10075 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
10076 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
10077 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
10078 support-email.
10079 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10080 @end deftypevr
10081
10082 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
10083 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
10084 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10085 @end deftypevr
10086
10087 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
10088 Workarounds for various client bugs:
10089
10090 @table @code
10091 @item delay-newmail
10092 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
10093 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
10094 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
10095 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
10096 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
10097 "Headers Only".
10098
10099 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
10100 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
10101 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
10102 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
10103
10104 @item tb-lsub-flags
10105 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g. mbox).
10106 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
10107 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
10108 @end table
10109 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10110 @end deftypevr
10111
10112 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
10113 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
10114 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10115 @end deftypevr
10116
10117
10118 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
10119 that GuixSD has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
10120 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
10121 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
10122 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
10123
10124 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
10125 and running. In that case, you can pass an
10126 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
10127 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
10128 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
10129
10130 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
10131
10132 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
10133 The dovecot package.
10134 @end deftypevr
10135
10136 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
10137 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
10138 @end deftypevr
10139
10140 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
10141 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
10142
10143 @example
10144 (dovecot-service #:config
10145 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
10146 (string "")))
10147 @end example
10148
10149 @node Web Services
10150 @subsubsection Web Services
10151
10152 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the following service:
10153
10154 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-service [#:nginx nginx] @
10155 [#:log-directory ``/var/log/nginx''] @
10156 [#:run-directory ``/var/run/nginx''] @
10157 [#:config-file]
10158
10159 Return a service that runs @var{nginx}, the nginx web server.
10160
10161 The nginx daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file}.
10162 Log files are written to @var{log-directory} and temporary runtime data
10163 files are written to @var{run-directory}. For proper operation, these
10164 arguments should match what is in @var{config-file} to ensure that the
10165 directories are created when the service is activated.
10166
10167 @end deffn
10168
10169 @node Miscellaneous Services
10170 @subsubsection Miscellaneous Services
10171
10172
10173 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
10174 @cindex rpcbind
10175
10176 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following:
10177
10178 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
10179 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
10180 @end defvr
10181
10182
10183 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
10184 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
10185 This type has the following parameters:
10186 @table @asis
10187 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
10188 The rpcbind package to use.
10189
10190 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
10191 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
10192 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
10193 instance.
10194 @end table
10195 @end deftp
10196
10197 @cindex lirc
10198 @subsubheading Lirc Service
10199
10200 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
10201
10202 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
10203 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
10204 [#:extra-options '()]
10205 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
10206 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
10207
10208 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
10209 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
10210 for details.
10211
10212 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
10213 passed to @command{lircd}.
10214 @end deffn
10215
10216 @cindex spice
10217 @subsubheading Spice Service
10218
10219 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
10220
10221 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
10222 Returns a service that runs @url{http://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
10223 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
10224 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
10225 @end deffn
10226
10227 @subsubsection Dictionary Services
10228 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
10229
10230 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
10231 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
10232 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
10233
10234 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
10235 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
10236 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictonary of English.
10237
10238 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
10239 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
10240 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
10241 @end deffn
10242
10243 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
10244 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
10245
10246 @table @asis
10247 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
10248 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
10249
10250 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
10251 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
10252 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
10253 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
10254
10255 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
10256 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
10257 @end table
10258 @end deftp
10259
10260 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
10261 Data type representing a dictionary database.
10262
10263 @table @asis
10264 @item @code{name}
10265 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
10266
10267 @item @code{module}
10268 Name of the dicod module used by this database
10269 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
10270
10271 @item @code{options}
10272 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
10273 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
10274 @end table
10275 @end deftp
10276
10277 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
10278 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
10279 Dictonary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
10280 @end defvr
10281
10282 @node Setuid Programs
10283 @subsection Setuid Programs
10284
10285 @cindex setuid programs
10286 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
10287 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
10288 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
10289 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
10290 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
10291 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
10292 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
10293 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
10294 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
10295
10296 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
10297 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
10298 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
10299 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
10300 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
10301 should be setuid root.
10302
10303 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
10304 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
10305 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
10306 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
10307 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
10308
10309 @example
10310 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
10311 @end example
10312
10313 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
10314 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
10315
10316 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
10317 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
10318
10319 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
10320 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
10321 @end defvr
10322
10323 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
10324 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
10325 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
10326 store.
10327
10328 @node X.509 Certificates
10329 @subsection X.509 Certificates
10330
10331 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
10332 @cindex X.509 certificates
10333 @cindex TLS
10334 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
10335 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
10336 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
10337 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
10338 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
10339 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
10340
10341 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
10342 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
10343 out-of-the-box.
10344
10345 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
10346 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
10347 certificates can be found.
10348
10349 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
10350 In GuixSD, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
10351 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
10352 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). GuixSD includes one such package,
10353 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
10354 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
10355
10356 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @var{%base-packages}, so you need to
10357 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
10358 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
10359 to the certificates installed globally.
10360
10361 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
10362 can also install their own certificate package in
10363 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
10364 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
10365 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
10366 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
10367 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
10368 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
10369 would typically run something like:
10370
10371 @example
10372 $ guix package -i nss-certs
10373 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
10374 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
10375 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
10376 @end example
10377
10378 @node Name Service Switch
10379 @subsection Name Service Switch
10380
10381 @cindex name service switch
10382 @cindex NSS
10383 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
10384 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
10385 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
10386 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
10387 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
10388 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
10389 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
10390 C Library Reference Manual}).
10391
10392 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
10393 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
10394 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
10395 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
10396 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
10397 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
10398
10399 @cindex nss-mdns
10400 @cindex .local, host name lookup
10401 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
10402 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
10403 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
10404 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
10405
10406 @example
10407 (name-service-switch
10408 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
10409
10410 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
10411 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
10412 (name-service
10413 (name "mdns_minimal")
10414
10415 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
10416 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
10417 ;; no need to try the next methods.
10418 (reaction (lookup-specification
10419 (not-found => return))))
10420
10421 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
10422 (name-service
10423 (name "dns"))
10424
10425 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
10426 (name-service
10427 (name "mdns")))))
10428 @end example
10429
10430 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
10431 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
10432 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
10433
10434 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
10435 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
10436 you also need to use @code{avahi-service} (@pxref{Networking Services,
10437 @code{avahi-service}}), or @var{%desktop-services}, which includes it
10438 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
10439 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
10440 @code{nscd-service}}).
10441
10442 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
10443 configurations.
10444
10445 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
10446 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
10447 @code{name-service-switch} object.
10448 @end defvr
10449
10450 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
10451 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
10452 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
10453 @end defvr
10454
10455 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
10456 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
10457 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
10458 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
10459 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
10460 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
10461 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
10462 run @command{guix system}.
10463
10464 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
10465
10466 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
10467 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
10468 system databases.
10469
10470 @table @code
10471 @item aliases
10472 @itemx ethers
10473 @itemx group
10474 @itemx gshadow
10475 @itemx hosts
10476 @itemx initgroups
10477 @itemx netgroup
10478 @itemx networks
10479 @itemx password
10480 @itemx public-key
10481 @itemx rpc
10482 @itemx services
10483 @itemx shadow
10484 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
10485 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
10486 @end table
10487 @end deftp
10488
10489 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
10490
10491 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
10492 associated lookup action.
10493
10494 @table @code
10495 @item name
10496 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
10497 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
10498
10499 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
10500 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
10501 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
10502 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
10503
10504 @item reaction
10505 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
10506 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
10507 Reference Manual}). For example:
10508
10509 @example
10510 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
10511 (success => return))
10512 @end example
10513 @end table
10514 @end deftp
10515
10516 @node Initial RAM Disk
10517 @subsection Initial RAM Disk
10518
10519 @cindex initial RAM disk (initrd)
10520 @cindex initrd (initial RAM disk)
10521 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
10522 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
10523 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
10524 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
10525 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
10526
10527 The @code{initrd} field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
10528 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
10529 system linux-initrd)} module provides two ways to build an initrd: the
10530 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure, and the low-level
10531 @code{expression->initrd} procedure.
10532
10533 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
10534 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
10535 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
10536 system declaration like this:
10537
10538 @example
10539 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
10540 ;; Create a standard initrd that has modules "foo.ko"
10541 ;; and "bar.ko", as well as their dependencies, in
10542 ;; addition to the modules available by default.
10543 (apply base-initrd file-systems
10544 #:extra-modules '("foo" "bar")
10545 rest)))
10546 @end example
10547
10548 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
10549 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
10550 volatile root file system.
10551
10552 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} honors several
10553 options passed on the Linux kernel command line (that is, arguments
10554 passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
10555 @code{-append} option) of QEMU, notably:
10556
10557 @table @code
10558 @item --load=@var{boot}
10559 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
10560 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
10561
10562 GuixSD uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
10563 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
10564 initialization system.
10565
10566 @item --root=@var{root}
10567 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
10568 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a partition label, or a partition
10569 UUID.
10570
10571 @item --system=@var{system}
10572 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
10573 @var{system}.
10574
10575 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
10576 @cindex module, black-listing
10577 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
10578 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
10579 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
10580 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
10581 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
10582
10583 @item --repl
10584 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
10585 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
10586 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
10587 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
10588 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
10589
10590 @end table
10591
10592 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
10593 @code{base-initrd} provide, here is how to use it and customize it
10594 further.
10595
10596 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
10597 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:virtio? #t] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
10598 [#:extra-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()]
10599 Return a monadic derivation that builds a generic initrd. @var{file-systems} is
10600 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
10601 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
10602 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
10603 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
10604
10605 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
10606 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
10607 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
10608
10609 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
10610 to it are lost.
10611
10612 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
10613 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. However, additional kernel
10614 modules can be listed in @var{extra-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
10615 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
10616 @end deffn
10617
10618 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
10619 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
10620 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
10621 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
10622 program to run in that initrd.
10623
10624 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
10625 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
10626 Return a derivation that builds a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
10627 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
10628 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
10629 automatically copied to the initrd.
10630 @end deffn
10631
10632 @node GRUB Configuration
10633 @subsection GRUB Configuration
10634
10635 @cindex GRUB
10636 @cindex boot loader
10637
10638 The operating system uses GNU@tie{}GRUB as its boot loader
10639 (@pxref{Overview, overview of GRUB,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). It is
10640 configured using a @code{grub-configuration} declaration. This data type
10641 is exported by the @code{(gnu system grub)} module and described below.
10642
10643 @deftp {Data Type} grub-configuration
10644 The type of a GRUB configuration declaration.
10645
10646 @table @asis
10647
10648 @item @code{device}
10649 This is a string denoting the boot device. It must be a device name
10650 understood by the @command{grub-install} command, such as
10651 @code{/dev/sda} or @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub,
10652 GNU GRUB Manual}).
10653
10654 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
10655 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
10656 entries to appear in the GRUB boot menu, in addition to the current
10657 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
10658
10659 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
10660 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
10661 current system.
10662
10663 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
10664 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
10665 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
10666
10667 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{%default-theme})
10668 The @code{grub-theme} object describing the theme to use.
10669 @end table
10670
10671 @end deftp
10672
10673 @cindex dual boot
10674 @cindex boot menu
10675 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
10676 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
10677 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
10678 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
10679 along these lines:
10680
10681 @example
10682 (menu-entry
10683 (label "The Other Distro")
10684 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
10685 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
10686 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
10687 @end example
10688
10689 Details below.
10690
10691 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
10692 The type of an entry in the GRUB boot menu.
10693
10694 @table @asis
10695
10696 @item @code{label}
10697 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
10698
10699 @item @code{linux}
10700 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
10701
10702 @example
10703 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
10704 @end example
10705
10706 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
10707 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
10708 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
10709
10710 @item @code{initrd}
10711 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
10712 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
10713
10714 @end table
10715 @end deftp
10716
10717 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
10718 Themes are created using the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not
10719 documented yet.
10720
10721 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
10722 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system, with a
10723 fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix logos.
10724 @end defvr
10725
10726
10727 @node Invoking guix system
10728 @subsection Invoking @code{guix system}
10729
10730 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
10731 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
10732 system} command. The synopsis is:
10733
10734 @example
10735 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
10736 @end example
10737
10738 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
10739 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
10740 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
10741 supported:
10742
10743 @table @code
10744 @item reconfigure
10745 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
10746 switch to it@footnote{This action is usable only on systems already
10747 running GuixSD.}.
10748
10749 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
10750 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
10751 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
10752 currently running; if a service is currently running, it does not
10753 attempt to upgrade it since this would not be possible without stopping it
10754 first.
10755
10756 It also adds a GRUB menu entry for the new OS configuration, and moves
10757 entries for older configurations to a submenu---unless
10758 @option{--no-grub} is passed.
10759
10760 @quotation Note
10761 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
10762 @c <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
10763 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
10764 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
10765 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
10766 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
10767 @end quotation
10768
10769 @item build
10770 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
10771 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
10772 This action does not actually install anything.
10773
10774 @item init
10775 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
10776 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
10777 installations of GuixSD. For instance:
10778
10779 @example
10780 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
10781 @end example
10782
10783 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
10784 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
10785 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
10786 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
10787 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
10788
10789 This command also installs GRUB on the device specified in
10790 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-grub} option was passed.
10791
10792 @item vm
10793 @cindex virtual machine
10794 @cindex VM
10795 @anchor{guix system vm}
10796 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
10797 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
10798 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU.
10799
10800 The VM shares its store with the host system.
10801
10802 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
10803 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
10804 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
10805 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
10806
10807 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
10808 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
10809 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
10810
10811 @example
10812 guix system vm my-config.scm \
10813 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
10814 @end example
10815
10816 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
10817 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
10818 store of the host can then be mounted.
10819
10820 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
10821 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
10822 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
10823 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
10824 size of the image.
10825
10826 @item vm-image
10827 @itemx disk-image
10828 Return a virtual machine or disk image of the operating system declared
10829 in @var{file} that stands alone. Use the @option{--image-size} option
10830 to specify the size of the image.
10831
10832 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
10833 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM},
10834 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
10835
10836 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
10837 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
10838 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
10839 using the following command:
10840
10841 @example
10842 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
10843 @end example
10844
10845 @item container
10846 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
10847 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
10848 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
10849 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
10850 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
10851 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
10852
10853 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
10854 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
10855 system.
10856
10857 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
10858 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
10859 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
10860
10861 @example
10862 guix system container my-config.scm \
10863 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
10864 @end example
10865
10866 @quotation Note
10867 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
10868 @end quotation
10869
10870 @end table
10871
10872 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
10873 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
10874 following:
10875
10876 @table @option
10877 @item --system=@var{system}
10878 @itemx -s @var{system}
10879 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
10880 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
10881
10882 @item --derivation
10883 @itemx -d
10884 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
10885 building anything.
10886
10887 @item --image-size=@var{size}
10888 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
10889 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
10890 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
10891 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
10892
10893 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
10894 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
10895 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
10896
10897 @table @code
10898 @item nothing-special
10899 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
10900
10901 @item backtrace
10902 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
10903
10904 @item debug
10905 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
10906 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
10907 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
10908 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
10909 a list of available debugging commands.
10910 @end table
10911 @end table
10912
10913 @quotation Note
10914 All the actions above, except @code{build} and @code{init},
10915 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
10916 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
10917 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
10918 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
10919 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
10920 @end quotation
10921
10922 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
10923 your GuixSD installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
10924 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
10925 GRUB boot menu:
10926
10927 @table @code
10928
10929 @item list-generations
10930 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
10931 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
10932 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
10933 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
10934
10935 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
10936 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
10937 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
10938 generations that are up to 10 days old:
10939
10940 @example
10941 $ guix system list-generations 10d
10942 @end example
10943
10944 @end table
10945
10946 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
10947 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
10948 each other:
10949
10950 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
10951 @table @code
10952
10953 @item extension-graph
10954 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
10955 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
10956 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
10957 extensions.)
10958
10959 The command:
10960
10961 @example
10962 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
10963 @end example
10964
10965 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
10966
10967 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
10968 @item shepherd-graph
10969 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
10970 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
10971 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
10972 example graph.
10973
10974 @end table
10975
10976 @node Running GuixSD in a VM
10977 @subsection Running GuixSD in a Virtual Machine
10978
10979 One way to run GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) is to build a GuixSD
10980 virtual machine image using @command{guix system vm-image}
10981 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format,
10982 which the @uref{http://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
10983
10984 To run the image in QEMU, copy it out of the store (@pxref{The Store})
10985 and give yourself permission to write to the copy. When invoking QEMU,
10986 you must choose a system emulator that is suitable for your hardware
10987 platform. Here is a minimal QEMU invocation that will boot the result
10988 of @command{guix system vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
10989
10990 @example
10991 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
10992 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
10993 -enable-kvm -m 256 /tmp/qemu-image
10994 @end example
10995
10996 Here is what each of these options means:
10997
10998 @table @code
10999 @item qemu-system-x86_64
11000 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
11001 host.
11002
11003 @item -net user
11004 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
11005 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
11006 guest OS online. If you do not choose a network stack, the boot will
11007 fail.
11008
11009 @item -net nic,model=virtio
11010 You must create a network interface of a given model. If you do not
11011 create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
11012 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
11013 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
11014
11015 @item -enable-kvm
11016 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
11017 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
11018 faster.
11019
11020 @item -m 256
11021 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
11022 which may be insufficient for some operations.
11023
11024 @item /tmp/qemu-image
11025 The file name of the qcow2 image.
11026 @end table
11027
11028 @node Defining Services
11029 @subsection Defining Services
11030
11031 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
11032 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
11033 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
11034
11035 @menu
11036 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
11037 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
11038 * Service Reference:: API reference.
11039 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
11040 @end menu
11041
11042 @node Service Composition
11043 @subsubsection Service Composition
11044
11045 @cindex services
11046 @cindex daemons
11047 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
11048 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
11049 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
11050 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
11051 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
11052 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
11053 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
11054 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
11055 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
11056 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
11057 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
11058 of the system.
11059
11060 @cindex service extensions
11061 GuixSD services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
11062 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the GuixSD
11063 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
11064 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
11065 Services, @code{lsh-service}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
11066 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
11067 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
11068 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
11069 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
11070 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
11071 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
11072
11073 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
11074 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
11075 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
11076
11077 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
11078
11079 @cindex system service
11080 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
11081 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
11082 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
11083 to learn about the other service types shown here.
11084 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
11085 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
11086 particular operating system definition.
11087
11088 @cindex service types
11089 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
11090 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
11091 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
11092 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @var{lsh-service-type}, with
11093 different parameters.
11094
11095 The following section describes the programming interface for service
11096 types and services.
11097
11098 @node Service Types and Services
11099 @subsubsection Service Types and Services
11100
11101 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
11102 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
11103 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
11104
11105 @example
11106 (define guix-service-type
11107 (service-type
11108 (name 'guix)
11109 (extensions
11110 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
11111 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
11112 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))))
11113 @end example
11114
11115 @noindent
11116 It defines two things:
11117
11118 @enumerate
11119 @item
11120 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
11121
11122 @item
11123 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
11124 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
11125 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
11126
11127 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
11128 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
11129 @end enumerate
11130
11131 In this example, @var{guix-service-type} extends three services:
11132
11133 @table @var
11134 @item shepherd-root-service-type
11135 The @var{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
11136 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
11137 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
11138 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
11139
11140 @item account-service-type
11141 This extension for this service is computed by @var{guix-accounts},
11142 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
11143 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
11144 guix-daemon}).
11145
11146 @item activation-service-type
11147 Here @var{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
11148 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
11149 booted.
11150 @end table
11151
11152 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
11153
11154 @example
11155 (service guix-service-type
11156 (guix-configuration
11157 (build-accounts 5)
11158 (use-substitutes? #f)))
11159 @end example
11160
11161 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
11162 the parameters of this specific service instance.
11163 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
11164 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type.
11165
11166 @var{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
11167 services but is not extensible itself.
11168
11169 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
11170
11171 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
11172
11173 @example
11174 (define udev-service-type
11175 (service-type (name 'udev)
11176 (extensions
11177 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
11178 udev-shepherd-service)))
11179
11180 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
11181 (extend (lambda (config rules)
11182 (match config
11183 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
11184 (udev-configuration
11185 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
11186 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
11187 @end example
11188
11189 This is the service type for the
11190 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
11191 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
11192 extension of @var{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
11193
11194 @table @code
11195 @item compose
11196 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
11197 services of this type.
11198
11199 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
11200 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
11201
11202 @item extend
11203 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
11204 the composition of the extensions.
11205
11206 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
11207 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
11208 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
11209 list of contributed rules.
11210 @end table
11211
11212 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
11213 @var{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
11214 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
11215
11216 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
11217 interface for services.
11218
11219 @node Service Reference
11220 @subsubsection Service Reference
11221
11222 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
11223 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
11224 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
11225 @code{(gnu services)} module.
11226
11227 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} @var{value}
11228 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
11229 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
11230 this particular service instance.
11231 @end deffn
11232
11233 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
11234 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
11235 @end deffn
11236
11237 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
11238 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
11239 @end deffn
11240
11241 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-parameters @var{service}
11242 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
11243 parameters.
11244 @end deffn
11245
11246 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
11247
11248 @example
11249 (define s
11250 (service nginx-service-type
11251 (nginx-configuration
11252 (nginx nginx)
11253 (log-directory log-directory)
11254 (run-directory run-directory)
11255 (file config-file))))
11256
11257 (service? s)
11258 @result{} #t
11259
11260 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
11261 @result{} #t
11262 @end example
11263
11264 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
11265 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
11266 @var{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
11267 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
11268 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
11269 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
11270 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
11271 common pattern.
11272
11273 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
11274 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
11275
11276 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
11277 clauses. Each clause has the form:
11278
11279 @example
11280 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
11281 @end example
11282
11283 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
11284 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
11285 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
11286 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
11287 @var{type}.
11288
11289 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
11290 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
11291 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
11292 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
11293 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
11294 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
11295
11296 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
11297
11298 @end deffn
11299
11300 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
11301 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
11302 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
11303 @code{operating-system} declaration.
11304
11305 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
11306 @cindex service type
11307 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
11308 and Services}).
11309
11310 @table @asis
11311 @item @code{name}
11312 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
11313
11314 @item @code{extensions}
11315 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
11316
11317 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
11318 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
11319 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
11320 services.
11321
11322 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
11323 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
11324 extensions. It must return a value that is a valid parameter value for
11325 the service instance.
11326
11327 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
11328 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
11329
11330 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
11331 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first argument
11332 and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension values as the
11333 second argument.
11334 @end table
11335
11336 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
11337 @end deftp
11338
11339 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
11340 @var{compute}
11341 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
11342 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
11343 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
11344 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
11345 @end deffn
11346
11347 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
11348 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
11349 @end deffn
11350
11351 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
11352 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
11353 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
11354 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
11355 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
11356 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
11357 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
11358
11359 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
11360 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
11361 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
11362 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
11363 @end deffn
11364
11365 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
11366 service types, some of which are listed below.
11367
11368 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
11369 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
11370 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
11371 @end defvr
11372
11373 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
11374 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
11375 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
11376 @end defvr
11377
11378 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
11379 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service can be extended by
11380 passing it name/file tuples such as:
11381
11382 @example
11383 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
11384 @end example
11385
11386 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
11387 pointing to the given file.
11388 @end defvr
11389
11390 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
11391 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
11392 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
11393 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
11394 @end defvr
11395
11396 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
11397 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
11398 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
11399 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
11400 @end defvr
11401
11402
11403 @node Shepherd Services
11404 @subsubsection Shepherd Services
11405
11406 @cindex PID 1
11407 @cindex init system
11408 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
11409 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the GuixSD
11410 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
11411 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
11412 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
11413
11414 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
11415 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
11416 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
11417 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
11418 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
11419
11420 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
11421
11422 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
11423 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
11424 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
11425
11426 The @var{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
11427 PID@tie{}1, of type @var{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
11428 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
11429
11430 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
11431 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
11432
11433 @table @asis
11434 @item @code{provision}
11435 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
11436
11437 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
11438 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
11439 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
11440 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
11441
11442 @item @code{requirements} (default: @code{'()})
11443 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
11444
11445 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
11446 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
11447 underlying process dies.
11448
11449 @item @code{start}
11450 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
11451 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
11452 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
11453 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
11454 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
11455 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
11456
11457 @item @code{documentation}
11458 A documentation string, as shown when running:
11459
11460 @example
11461 herd doc @var{service-name}
11462 @end example
11463
11464 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @var{provision}
11465 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
11466
11467 @item @code{modules} (default: @var{%default-modules})
11468 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
11469 @code{stop} are evaluated.
11470
11471 @end table
11472 @end deftp
11473
11474 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
11475 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
11476
11477 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
11478 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
11479 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
11480 @end defvr
11481
11482 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
11483 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
11484 @end defvr
11485
11486
11487 @node Installing Debugging Files
11488 @section Installing Debugging Files
11489
11490 @cindex debugging files
11491 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
11492 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
11493 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
11494 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
11495 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
11496
11497 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
11498 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
11499 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
11500 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
11501 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
11502 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
11503 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
11504
11505 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
11506 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
11507 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
11508 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
11509 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
11510 with GDB}).
11511
11512 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
11513 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
11514 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
11515 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
11516 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
11517 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
11518 Guile:
11519
11520 @example
11521 guix package -i glibc:debug guile:debug
11522 @end example
11523
11524 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
11525 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
11526 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
11527 GDB}):
11528
11529 @example
11530 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
11531 @end example
11532
11533 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
11534 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
11535
11536 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
11537 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
11538 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
11539 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
11540 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
11541 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
11542
11543 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
11544 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
11545 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
11546 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
11547 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
11548 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
11549 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
11550 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
11551
11552
11553 @node Security Updates
11554 @section Security Updates
11555
11556 @cindex security updates
11557 @cindex security vulnerabilities
11558 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
11559 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
11560 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
11561 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
11562 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
11563 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
11564 distribution:
11565
11566 @smallexample
11567 $ guix lint -c cve
11568 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc-2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
11569 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc-4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
11570 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg-2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
11571 @dots{}
11572 @end smallexample
11573
11574 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
11575
11576 @quotation Note
11577 As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described below is considered
11578 ``beta''.
11579 @end quotation
11580
11581 Guix follows a functional
11582 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
11583 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
11584 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
11585 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
11586 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
11587 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
11588 desired.
11589
11590 @cindex grafts
11591 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
11592 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
11593 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
11594 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
11595 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
11596 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
11597 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
11598
11599 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
11600 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
11601 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
11602 Bash, say @var{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
11603 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
11604 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
11605
11606 @example
11607 (define bash
11608 (package
11609 (name "bash")
11610 ;; @dots{}
11611 (replacement bash-fixed)))
11612 @end example
11613
11614 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
11615 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
11616 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
11617 @var{bash-fixed} instead of @var{bash}. This grafting process takes
11618 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
11619 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
11620 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
11621 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
11622
11623 Currently, the graft and the package it replaces (@var{bash-fixed} and
11624 @var{bash} in the example above) must have the exact same @code{name}
11625 and @code{version} fields. This restriction mostly comes from the fact
11626 that grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
11627 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
11628 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
11629 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
11630
11631 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
11632 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
11633 Thus, the command:
11634
11635 @example
11636 guix build bash --no-grafts
11637 @end example
11638
11639 @noindent
11640 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
11641
11642 @example
11643 guix build bash
11644 @end example
11645
11646 @noindent
11647 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
11648 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
11649
11650 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
11651 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
11652
11653 @example
11654 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
11655 @end example
11656
11657 @noindent
11658 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
11659 Likewise for a complete GuixSD system generation:
11660
11661 @example
11662 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
11663 @end example
11664
11665 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
11666 @command{lsof} command:
11667
11668 @example
11669 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
11670 @end example
11671
11672
11673 @node Package Modules
11674 @section Package Modules
11675
11676 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
11677 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
11678 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
11679 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
11680 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
11681 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
11682 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
11683 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
11684 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
11685 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
11686 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
11687
11688 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
11689 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
11690 instance, when running @code{guix package -i emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
11691 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
11692 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
11693 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
11694
11695 @cindex customization, of packages
11696 @cindex package module search path
11697 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
11698 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
11699 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
11700 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
11701 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
11702 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
11703 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. These package definitions
11704 will not be visible by default. Users can invoke commands such as
11705 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} with the
11706 @code{-e} option so that they know where to find the package. Better
11707 yet, they can use the
11708 @code{-L} option of these commands to make those modules visible
11709 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--load-path}}), or define the
11710 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} environment variable. This environment
11711 variable makes it easy to extend or customize the distribution and is
11712 honored by all the user interfaces.
11713
11714 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
11715 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
11716 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
11717 over the own modules of the distribution.
11718 @end defvr
11719
11720 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
11721 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
11722 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
11723 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
11724 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
11725 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
11726
11727 @node Packaging Guidelines
11728 @section Packaging Guidelines
11729
11730 The GNU distribution is nascent and may well lack some of your favorite
11731 packages. This section describes how you can help make the distribution
11732 grow. @xref{Contributing}, for additional information on how you can
11733 help.
11734
11735 Free software packages are usually distributed in the form of
11736 @dfn{source code tarballs}---typically @file{tar.gz} files that contain
11737 all the source files. Adding a package to the distribution means
11738 essentially two things: adding a @dfn{recipe} that describes how to
11739 build the package, including a list of other packages required to build
11740 it, and adding @dfn{package metadata} along with that recipe, such as a
11741 description and licensing information.
11742
11743 In Guix all this information is embodied in @dfn{package definitions}.
11744 Package definitions provide a high-level view of the package. They are
11745 written using the syntax of the Scheme programming language; in fact,
11746 for each package we define a variable bound to the package definition,
11747 and export that variable from a module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
11748 However, in-depth Scheme knowledge is @emph{not} a prerequisite for
11749 creating packages. For more information on package definitions,
11750 @pxref{Defining Packages}.
11751
11752 Once a package definition is in place, stored in a file in the Guix
11753 source tree, it can be tested using the @command{guix build} command
11754 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). For example, assuming the new package is
11755 called @code{gnew}, you may run this command from the Guix build tree
11756 (@pxref{Running Guix Before It Is Installed}):
11757
11758 @example
11759 ./pre-inst-env guix build gnew --keep-failed
11760 @end example
11761
11762 Using @code{--keep-failed} makes it easier to debug build failures since
11763 it provides access to the failed build tree. Another useful
11764 command-line option when debugging is @code{--log-file}, to access the
11765 build log.
11766
11767 If the package is unknown to the @command{guix} command, it may be that
11768 the source file contains a syntax error, or lacks a @code{define-public}
11769 clause to export the package variable. To figure it out, you may load
11770 the module from Guile to get more information about the actual error:
11771
11772 @example
11773 ./pre-inst-env guile -c '(use-modules (gnu packages gnew))'
11774 @end example
11775
11776 Once your package builds correctly, please send us a patch
11777 (@pxref{Contributing}). Well, if you need help, we will be happy to
11778 help you too. Once the patch is committed in the Guix repository, the
11779 new package automatically gets built on the supported platforms by
11780 @url{http://hydra.gnu.org/jobset/gnu/master, our continuous integration
11781 system}.
11782
11783 @cindex substituter
11784 Users can obtain the new package definition simply by running
11785 @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). When
11786 @code{hydra.gnu.org} is done building the package, installing the
11787 package automatically downloads binaries from there
11788 (@pxref{Substitutes}). The only place where human intervention is
11789 needed is to review and apply the patch.
11790
11791
11792 @menu
11793 * Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
11794 * Package Naming:: What's in a name?
11795 * Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
11796 * Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
11797 * Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
11798 * Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
11799 * Java Packages:: Coffee break.
11800 * Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
11801 @end menu
11802
11803 @node Software Freedom
11804 @subsection Software Freedom
11805
11806 @c Adapted from http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/philosophy.html.
11807
11808 The GNU operating system has been developed so that users can have
11809 freedom in their computing. GNU is @dfn{free software}, meaning that
11810 users have the @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,four
11811 essential freedoms}: to run the program, to study and change the program
11812 in source code form, to redistribute exact copies, and to distribute
11813 modified versions. Packages found in the GNU distribution provide only
11814 software that conveys these four freedoms.
11815
11816 In addition, the GNU distribution follow the
11817 @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-system-distribution-guidelines.html,free
11818 software distribution guidelines}. Among other things, these guidelines
11819 reject non-free firmware, recommendations of non-free software, and
11820 discuss ways to deal with trademarks and patents.
11821
11822 Some otherwise free upstream package sources contain a small and optional
11823 subset that violates the above guidelines, for instance because this subset
11824 is itself non-free code. When that happens, the offending items are removed
11825 with appropriate patches or code snippets in the @code{origin} form of the
11826 package (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This way, @code{guix
11827 build --source} returns the ``freed'' source rather than the unmodified
11828 upstream source.
11829
11830
11831 @node Package Naming
11832 @subsection Package Naming
11833
11834 A package has actually two names associated with it:
11835 First, there is the name of the @emph{Scheme variable}, the one following
11836 @code{define-public}. By this name, the package can be made known in the
11837 Scheme code, for instance as input to another package. Second, there is
11838 the string in the @code{name} field of a package definition. This name
11839 is used by package management commands such as
11840 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build}.
11841
11842 Both are usually the same and correspond to the lowercase conversion of
11843 the project name chosen upstream, with underscores replaced with
11844 hyphens. For instance, GNUnet is available as @code{gnunet}, and
11845 SDL_net as @code{sdl-net}.
11846
11847 We do not add @code{lib} prefixes for library packages, unless these are
11848 already part of the official project name. But @pxref{Python
11849 Modules} and @ref{Perl Modules} for special rules concerning modules for
11850 the Python and Perl languages.
11851
11852 Font package names are handled differently, @pxref{Fonts}.
11853
11854
11855 @node Version Numbers
11856 @subsection Version Numbers
11857
11858 We usually package only the latest version of a given free software
11859 project. But sometimes, for instance for incompatible library versions,
11860 two (or more) versions of the same package are needed. These require
11861 different Scheme variable names. We use the name as defined
11862 in @ref{Package Naming}
11863 for the most recent version; previous versions use the same name, suffixed
11864 by @code{-} and the smallest prefix of the version number that may
11865 distinguish the two versions.
11866
11867 The name inside the package definition is the same for all versions of a
11868 package and does not contain any version number.
11869
11870 For instance, the versions 2.24.20 and 3.9.12 of GTK+ may be packaged as follows:
11871
11872 @example
11873 (define-public gtk+
11874 (package
11875 (name "gtk+")
11876 (version "3.9.12")
11877 ...))
11878 (define-public gtk+-2
11879 (package
11880 (name "gtk+")
11881 (version "2.24.20")
11882 ...))
11883 @end example
11884 If we also wanted GTK+ 3.8.2, this would be packaged as
11885 @example
11886 (define-public gtk+-3.8
11887 (package
11888 (name "gtk+")
11889 (version "3.8.2")
11890 ...))
11891 @end example
11892
11893 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2016-01/msg00425.html>,
11894 @c for a discussion of what follows.
11895 @cindex version number, for VCS snapshots
11896 Occasionally, we package snapshots of upstream's version control system
11897 (VCS) instead of formal releases. This should remain exceptional,
11898 because it is up to upstream developers to clarify what the stable
11899 release is. Yet, it is sometimes necessary. So, what should we put in
11900 the @code{version} field?
11901
11902 Clearly, we need to make the commit identifier of the VCS snapshot
11903 visible in the version string, but we also need to make sure that the
11904 version string is monotonically increasing so that @command{guix package
11905 --upgrade} can determine which version is newer. Since commit
11906 identifiers, notably with Git, are not monotonically increasing, we add
11907 a revision number that we increase each time we upgrade to a newer
11908 snapshot. The resulting version string looks like this:
11909
11910 @example
11911 2.0.11-3.cabba9e
11912 ^ ^ ^
11913 | | `-- upstream commit ID
11914 | |
11915 | `--- Guix package revision
11916 |
11917 latest upstream version
11918 @end example
11919
11920 It is a good idea to strip commit identifiers in the @code{version}
11921 field to, say, 7 digits. It avoids an aesthetic annoyance (assuming
11922 aesthetics have a role to play here) as well as problems related to OS
11923 limits such as the maximum shebang length (127 bytes for the Linux
11924 kernel.) It is best to use the full commit identifiers in
11925 @code{origin}s, though, to avoid ambiguities. A typical package
11926 definition may look like this:
11927
11928 @example
11929 (define my-package
11930 (let ((commit "c3f29bc928d5900971f65965feaae59e1272a3f7")
11931 (revision "1")) ;Guix package revision
11932 (package
11933 (version (string-append "0.9-" revision "."
11934 (string-take commit 7)))
11935 (source (origin
11936 (method git-fetch)
11937 (uri (git-reference
11938 (url "git://example.org/my-package.git")
11939 (commit commit)))
11940 (sha256 (base32 "1mbikn@dots{}"))
11941 (file-name (string-append "my-package-" version
11942 "-checkout"))))
11943 ;; @dots{}
11944 )))
11945 @end example
11946
11947 @node Synopses and Descriptions
11948 @subsection Synopses and Descriptions
11949
11950 As we have seen before, each package in GNU@tie{}Guix includes a
11951 synopsis and a description (@pxref{Defining Packages}). Synopses and
11952 descriptions are important: They are what @command{guix package
11953 --search} searches, and a crucial piece of information to help users
11954 determine whether a given package suits their needs. Consequently,
11955 packagers should pay attention to what goes into them.
11956
11957 Synopses must start with a capital letter and must not end with a
11958 period. They must not start with ``a'' or ``the'', which usually does
11959 not bring anything; for instance, prefer ``File-frobbing tool'' over ``A
11960 tool that frobs files''. The synopsis should say what the package
11961 is---e.g., ``Core GNU utilities (file, text, shell)''---or what it is
11962 used for---e.g., the synopsis for GNU@tie{}grep is ``Print lines
11963 matching a pattern''.
11964
11965 Keep in mind that the synopsis must be meaningful for a very wide
11966 audience. For example, ``Manipulate alignments in the SAM format''
11967 might make sense for a seasoned bioinformatics researcher, but might be
11968 fairly unhelpful or even misleading to a non-specialized audience. It
11969 is a good idea to come up with a synopsis that gives an idea of the
11970 application domain of the package. In this example, this might give
11971 something like ``Manipulate nucleotide sequence alignments'', which
11972 hopefully gives the user a better idea of whether this is what they are
11973 looking for.
11974
11975 Descriptions should take between five and ten lines. Use full
11976 sentences, and avoid using acronyms without first introducing them.
11977 Please avoid marketing phrases such as ``world-leading'',
11978 ``industrial-strength'', and ``next-generation'', and avoid superlatives
11979 like ``the most advanced''---they are not helpful to users looking for a
11980 package and may even sound suspicious. Instead, try to be factual,
11981 mentioning use cases and features.
11982
11983 @cindex Texinfo markup, in package descriptions
11984 Descriptions can include Texinfo markup, which is useful to introduce
11985 ornaments such as @code{@@code} or @code{@@dfn}, bullet lists, or
11986 hyperlinks (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). However you
11987 should be careful when using some characters for example @samp{@@} and
11988 curly braces which are the basic special characters in Texinfo
11989 (@pxref{Special Characters,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). User interfaces
11990 such as @command{guix package --show} take care of rendering it
11991 appropriately.
11992
11993 Synopses and descriptions are translated by volunteers
11994 @uref{http://translationproject.org/domain/guix-packages.html, at the
11995 Translation Project} so that as many users as possible can read them in
11996 their native language. User interfaces search them and display them in
11997 the language specified by the current locale.
11998
11999 Translation is a lot of work so, as a packager, please pay even more
12000 attention to your synopses and descriptions as every change may entail
12001 additional work for translators. In order to help them, it is possible
12002 to make recommendations or instructions visible to them by inserting
12003 special comments like this (@pxref{xgettext Invocation,,, gettext, GNU
12004 Gettext}):
12005
12006 @example
12007 ;; TRANSLATORS: "X11 resize-and-rotate" should not be translated.
12008 (description "ARandR is designed to provide a simple visual front end
12009 for the X11 resize-and-rotate (RandR) extension. @dots{}")
12010 @end example
12011
12012
12013 @node Python Modules
12014 @subsection Python Modules
12015
12016 We currently package Python 2 and Python 3, under the Scheme variable names
12017 @code{python-2} and @code{python} as explained in @ref{Version Numbers}.
12018 To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages, it
12019 seems desirable that the name of a package for a Python module contains
12020 the word @code{python}.
12021
12022 Some modules are compatible with only one version of Python, others with both.
12023 If the package Foo compiles only with Python 3, we name it
12024 @code{python-foo}; if it compiles only with Python 2, we name it
12025 @code{python2-foo}. If it is compatible with both versions, we create two
12026 packages with the corresponding names.
12027
12028 If a project already contains the word @code{python}, we drop this;
12029 for instance, the module python-dateutil is packaged under the names
12030 @code{python-dateutil} and @code{python2-dateutil}. If the project name
12031 starts with @code{py} (e.g. @code{pytz}), we keep it and prefix it as
12032 described above.
12033
12034
12035 @node Perl Modules
12036 @subsection Perl Modules
12037
12038 Perl programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
12039 using the lowercase upstream name.
12040 For Perl packages containing a single class, we use the lowercase class name,
12041 replace all occurrences of @code{::} by dashes and prepend the prefix
12042 @code{perl-}.
12043 So the class @code{XML::Parser} becomes @code{perl-xml-parser}.
12044 Modules containing several classes keep their lowercase upstream name and
12045 are also prepended by @code{perl-}. Such modules tend to have the word
12046 @code{perl} somewhere in their name, which gets dropped in favor of the
12047 prefix. For instance, @code{libwww-perl} becomes @code{perl-libwww}.
12048
12049
12050 @node Java Packages
12051 @subsection Java Packages
12052
12053 Java programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
12054 using the lowercase upstream name.
12055
12056 To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages,
12057 it is desirable that the name of a package for a Java package is
12058 prefixed with @code{java-}. If a project already contains the word
12059 @code{java}, we drop this; for instance, the package @code{ngsjava} is
12060 packaged under the name @code{java-ngs}.
12061
12062 For Java packages containing a single class or a small class hierarchy,
12063 we use the lowercase class name, replace all occurrences of @code{.} by
12064 dashes and prepend the prefix @code{java-}. So the class
12065 @code{apache.commons.cli} becomes package
12066 @code{java-apache-commons-cli}.
12067
12068
12069 @node Fonts
12070 @subsection Fonts
12071
12072 For fonts that are in general not installed by a user for typesetting
12073 purposes, or that are distributed as part of a larger software package,
12074 we rely on the general packaging rules for software; for instance, this
12075 applies to the fonts delivered as part of the X.Org system or fonts that
12076 are part of TeX Live.
12077
12078 To make it easier for a user to search for fonts, names for other packages
12079 containing only fonts are constructed as follows, independently of the
12080 upstream package name.
12081
12082 The name of a package containing only one font family starts with
12083 @code{font-}; it is followed by the foundry name and a dash @code{-}
12084 if the foundry is known, and the font family name, in which spaces are
12085 replaced by dashes (and as usual, all upper case letters are transformed
12086 to lower case).
12087 For example, the Gentium font family by SIL is packaged under the name
12088 @code{font-sil-gentium}.
12089
12090 For a package containing several font families, the name of the collection
12091 is used in the place of the font family name.
12092 For instance, the Liberation fonts consist of three families,
12093 Liberation Sans, Liberation Serif and Liberation Mono.
12094 These could be packaged separately under the names
12095 @code{font-liberation-sans} and so on; but as they are distributed together
12096 under a common name, we prefer to package them together as
12097 @code{font-liberation}.
12098
12099 In the case where several formats of the same font family or font collection
12100 are packaged separately, a short form of the format, prepended by a dash,
12101 is added to the package name. We use @code{-ttf} for TrueType fonts,
12102 @code{-otf} for OpenType fonts and @code{-type1} for PostScript Type 1
12103 fonts.
12104
12105
12106
12107 @node Bootstrapping
12108 @section Bootstrapping
12109
12110 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
12111
12112 @cindex bootstrapping
12113
12114 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
12115 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
12116 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
12117 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
12118 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
12119 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
12120 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
12121 a ``regular user''.
12122
12123 @cindex bootstrap binaries
12124 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
12125 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
12126 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
12127 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
12128 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
12129 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
12130 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
12131 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
12132 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
12133
12134 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
12135 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
12136
12137 @unnumberedsubsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
12138
12139 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
12140 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
12141 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
12142
12143 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
12144 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
12145 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
12146 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
12147
12148 @example
12149 guix graph -t derivation \
12150 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
12151 | dot -Tps > t.ps
12152 @end example
12153
12154 At this level of detail, things are
12155 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
12156 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
12157 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
12158 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
12159 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
12160 (@pxref{The Store}).
12161
12162 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
12163 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
12164 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
12165 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
12166 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
12167 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
12168 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
12169 tarball to be unpacked.
12170
12171 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
12172 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
12173 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
12174 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
12175 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
12176 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
12177 in the store, using the original layout. The
12178 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
12179 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
12180 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
12181 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
12182
12183 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
12184 derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
12185 etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
12186
12187
12188 @unnumberedsubsec Building the Build Tools
12189
12190 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
12191 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
12192 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
12193 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
12194 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
12195 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
12196 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
12197
12198 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
12199 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
12200 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
12201 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
12202 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
12203 package from source. The command:
12204
12205 @example
12206 guix graph -t bag \
12207 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
12208 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
12209 @end example
12210
12211 @noindent
12212 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
12213 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
12214 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
12215 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
12216
12217 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
12218
12219 @c See <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
12220 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
12221 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
12222 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
12223 built.
12224
12225 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
12226 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
12227 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
12228 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
12229
12230 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
12231 GCC uses @code{ld}
12232 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
12233 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
12234 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
12235
12236 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
12237 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
12238 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
12239 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
12240 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
12241
12242
12243 @unnumberedsubsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
12244
12245 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
12246 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
12247 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
12248 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
12249
12250 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
12251 binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
12252 of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
12253
12254 @example
12255 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
12256 @end example
12257
12258 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
12259 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
12260 this section.
12261
12262 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
12263 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
12264 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
12265 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
12266 know.
12267
12268 @node Porting
12269 @section Porting to a New Platform
12270
12271 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
12272 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
12273 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
12274 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
12275 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
12276 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
12277 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
12278
12279 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
12280 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
12281 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
12282 one:
12283
12284 @example
12285 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
12286 @end example
12287
12288 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
12289 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
12290 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
12291 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
12292 taught about the new platform.
12293
12294 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
12295 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
12296 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
12297 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
12298 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
12299 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules do download it for
12300 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
12301 as well.
12302
12303 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
12304 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
12305 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
12306 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
12307 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
12308 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
12309 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
12310 reason.
12311
12312 @c *********************************************************************
12313 @include contributing.texi
12314
12315 @c *********************************************************************
12316 @node Acknowledgments
12317 @chapter Acknowledgments
12318
12319 Guix is based on the @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
12320 which was designed and
12321 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
12322 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
12323 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
12324 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
12325 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
12326
12327 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
12328 an inspiration for Guix.
12329
12330 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
12331 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
12332 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
12333 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
12334 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
12335
12336
12337 @c *********************************************************************
12338 @node GNU Free Documentation License
12339 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
12340
12341 @include fdl-1.3.texi
12342
12343 @c *********************************************************************
12344 @node Concept Index
12345 @unnumbered Concept Index
12346 @printindex cp
12347
12348 @node Programming Index
12349 @unnumbered Programming Index
12350 @syncodeindex tp fn
12351 @syncodeindex vr fn
12352 @printindex fn
12353
12354 @bye
12355
12356 @c Local Variables:
12357 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
12358 @c End: